0% found this document useful (0 votes)
69 views308 pages

78 21139

Copyright
© Attribution Non-Commercial (BY-NC)
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
69 views308 pages

78 21139

Copyright
© Attribution Non-Commercial (BY-NC)
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 308

ADMINISTRATION GUIDE

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide Release 1.2.9

Contents

Chapter 1: Getting Started


Starting the Web-based Switch Configuration Utility
Launching the Configuration Utility Logging In HTTP/HTTPS Password Expiration Logging Out

1
1
2 2 3 3 4

Quick Start Switch Configuration Interface Naming Conventions Window Navigation


Application Header Management Buttons

5 5 7
7 9

Chapter 2: Statistics and Statistics


Viewing Ethernet Interfaces Viewing Etherlike Statistics Viewing 802.1X EAP Statistics Managing RMON
Viewing RMON Statistics

11
11 12 13 15
15

Chapter 3: Administration: System Log


Setting System Log Settings Setting Remote Logging Settings Viewing Memory Logs
RAM Memory Flash Memory

19
19 21 22
22 23

Chapter 4: Administration: File Management


Types of System Files Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language
Upgrading/Backing Up Firmware or Language File

25
25 28
28

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Contents

Downloading or Backing-up a Configuration or Log Viewing Configuration Files Properties Copying Configuration Files DHCP Auto Configuration
Triggering DHCP Auto Configuration Server Name/Address Backup Configuration File Name Auto Configuration Process Configuring DHCP Auto Configuration

30 33 34 36
36 36 36 37 37

Chapter 5: Administration: General Information


Switch Models System Information
Displaying the System Summary Configuring the System Settings

41
41 43
43 44

Rebooting the Switch Monitoring Fan Status Defining Idle Session Timeout Pinging a Host

45 47 47 48

Chapter 6: Administration: Time Settings


System Time Options SNTP Modes Configuring System Time
Selecting Source of System Time Adding a Unicast SNTP Server Configuring the SNTP Mode Defining SNTP Authentication

51
52 53 54
54 56 59 59

Chapter 7: Administration: Diagnostics


Testing Copper Ports

61
61

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Contents

Displaying Optical Module Status Configuring Port and VLAN Mirroring Viewing CPU Utilization and Secure Core Technology

63 64 66

Chapter 8: Administration: Discovery


Configuring Bonjour Discovery
Bonjour in Layer 2 System Mode

69
69
69

LLDP and CDP Configuring LLDP


LLDP Overview Setting LLDP Properties Editing LLDP Port Settings LLDP MED Configuring LLDP MED Port Settings Displaying LLDP Port Status Displaying LLDP Local Information Displaying LLDP Neighbors Information Accessing LLDP Statistics LLDP Overloading

70 71
72 73 74 76 78 80 81 84 89 89

Configuring CDP
Setting CDP Properties Editing CDP Interface Settings Displaying CDP Local Information Displaying CDP Neighbors Information Viewing CDP Statistics

92
92 94 96 98 99

Chapter 9: Port Management


Configuring Ports Setting Basic Port Configuration Configuring Link Aggregation
Link Aggregation Overview

101
101 102 105
105

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Contents

Static and Dynamic LAG Workflow Defining LAG Management Configuring LAG Settings Configuring LACP

107 107 108 110

Configuring Green Ethernet


Green Ethernet Overview Setting Global Green Ethernet Properties Setting Green Ethernet Properties for Ports

112
112 116 117

Chapter 10: Smartport


Overview What is a Smartport Smartport Types
Special Smartport Types

121
121 122 122
124

Smartport Macros
Applying a Smartport Type to an Interface

125
125

Macro Failure and the Reset Operation How the Smartport Feature Works Auto Smartport
Enabling Auto Smartport Identifying Smartport Type Multiple Devices Attached to the Port Persistent Auto Smartport Interface

126 127 127


128 128 130 131

Error Handling Default Configuration Relationships with Other Features and Backwards Compatibility Common Smartport Tasks Configuring Smartport Using The Web-based Interface
Smartport Properties Smartport Type Settings Smartport Interface Settings

131 131 132 132 134


135 136 137

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Contents

Built-in Smartport Macros

139

Chapter 11: Port Management: PoE


PoE on the Switch
PoE Features PoE Operation PoE Configuration Considerations

151
151
151 152 152

Configuring PoE Properties Configuring PoE Settings

154 155

Chapter 12: VLAN Management


VLANs Configuring Default VLAN Settings Creating VLANs Configuring VLAN Interface Settings Defining VLAN Membership
Configuring Port to VLAN Configuring VLAN Membership

159
159 162 163 164 165
166 167

Voice VLAN
Voice VLAN Overview Configuring Voice VLAN Configuring Telephony OUI

168
169 175 179

Chapter 13: Spanning Tree


STP Flavors Configuring STP Status and Global Settings Defining Spanning Tree Interface Settings Configuring Rapid Spanning Tree Settings

183
183 184 186 188

Chapter 14: Managing MAC Address Tables


Types of MAC Addresses

191
191

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Contents

Configuring Static MAC Addresses Managing Dynamic MAC Addresses


Configuring Dynamic MAC Address Aging Time Querying Dynamic Addresses

192 192
193 193

Chapter 15: Multicast


Multicast Forwarding
Typical Multicast Setup Multicast Operation Multicast Registration Multicast Address Properties

195
195
196 196 197 198

Defining Multicast Properties Adding MAC Group Address Adding IP Multicast Group Addresses Configuring IGMP Snooping MLD Snooping Querying IGMP/MLD IP Multicast Group Defining Multicast Router Ports Defining Forward All Multicast Defining Unregistered Multicast Settings

198 200 202 203 205 208 209 210 211

Chapter 16: IP Configuration


Management and IP Interfaces
Managing IPv6 Defining IPv6 Global Configuration Defining an IPv6 Interface Defining IPv6 Addresses Defining an IPv6 Default Router List Configuring IPv6 Tunnels Defining IPv6 Neighbors Information Viewing IPv6 Route Tables

213
213
216 216 217 218 219 221 222 224

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Contents

Configuring ARP Domain Name Systems


Defining DNS Servers Mapping DNS Hosts

225 226
227 228

Chapter 17: Security


Defining Users
Setting User Accounts Setting Password Complexity Rules

231
232
232 233

Configuring RADIUS
Accounting Using a RADIUS Server Defaults Interactions With Other Features Workflow

235
235 235 236 236

Configuring Management Access Authentication Defining Management Access Method


Active Access Profile Defining Profile Rules

239 240
240 242

Configuring TCP/UDP Services Defining Storm Control Configuring Port Security Configuring 802.1X
802.1X Parameters Workflow Defining 802.1X Properties Defining 802.1X Port Authentication Defining Host and Session Authentication Viewing Authenticated Hosts

244 246 247 249


250 251 252 254 255

Denial of Service Prevention


Secure Core Technology (SCT) Types of DoS Attacks Defense Against DoS Attacks

256
256 257 257

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Contents

Dependencies Between Features Default Configuration Configuring DoS Prevention

257 258 258

Chapter 18: Security: SSL Server


SSL Overview Default Settings and Configuration SSL Server Authentication Settings

261
261 261 262

Chapter 19: Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Introduction
SSD Management

265
265
266

SSD Rules SSD Properties


Passphrase Default and User-defined Passphrases Local Passphrase Configuration File Passphrase Control Configuration File Integrity Control Read Mode

266 271
271 272 272 272 273 273

Configuration Files
File SSD Indicator SSD Control Block Startup Configuration File Running Configuration File Backup and Mirror Configuration File Sensitive Data Zero-Touch Auto Configuration

274
274 275 275 276 277 277

SSD Management Channels Menu CLI and Password Recovery Configuring SSD
SSD Properties

278 279 279


280

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Contents

SSD Rules

280

Chapter 20: Quality of Service


QoS Features and Components
QoS Operation QoS Workflow

283
283
284 284

Configuring QoS - General


Setting QoS Properties Interface QoS Settings Configuring QoS Queues Mapping CoS/802.1p to a Queue Mapping DSCP to Queue Configuring Bandwidth Configuring Egress Shaping per Queue

285
285 286 287 289 290 291 292

Managing QoS Statistics


Viewing Queues Statistics

293
293

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

10

Contents

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

11

1
Getting Started
This section provides an introduction to the web-based configuration utility, and covers the following topics: Starting the Web-based Switch Configuration Utility Quick Start Switch Configuration Interface Naming Conventions Window Navigation

Starting the Web-based Switch Configuration Utility


This section describes how to navigate the web-based configuration utility. If you are using a pop-up blocker, make sure it is disabled. Browsers have the following restrictions: If you are using older versions of Internet Explorer, you cannot directly use an IPv6 address to access the switch. You can, however, use the DNS (Domain Name System) server to create a domain name that contains the IPv6 address, and then use that domain name in the address bar in place of the IPv6 address. If you have multiple IPv6 interfaces on your management station, use the IPv6 global address instead of the IPv6 link local address to access the switch from your browser.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Getting Started
Starting the Web-based Switch Configuration Utility

Launching the Configuration Utility


To open the web-based configuration utility:
STEP 1 Open a Web browser. STEP 2 Enter the IP address of the switch you are configuring in the address bar on the

browser, and then press Enter. The Login page appears.


NOTE When the switch is using the factory default IP address of 192.168.1.254, its power

LED flashes continuously. When the switch is using a DHCP assigned IP address or an administrator-configured static IP address, the power LED is on solid.

Logging In
The default username is cisco and the default password is cisco. The first time that you log in with the default username and password, you are required to enter a new password.
NOTE If you have not previously selected a language for the GUI, the language of the Login

page is determined by the language(s) requested by your browser and the languages configured on your switch. If your browser requests Chinese, for example, and Chinese has been loaded into your switch, the Login page is automatically displayed in Chinese. If Chinese has not been loaded into your switch, the Login page appears in English. The languages loaded into the switch have a language and country code (en-US, en-GB and so on). For the Login page to be automatically displayed in a particular language, based on the browser request, both the language and country code of the browser request must match those of the language loaded on the switch. If the browser request contains only the language code without a country code (for example: fr). The first embedded language with a matching language code is taken (without matching the country code, for example: fr_CA). To log in to the device configuration utility:
STEP 1 Enter the username/password. The password can contain up to 64 ASCII

characters. Password-complexity rules are described in the Setting Password Complexity Rules section of the Configuring Security chapter.
STEP 2 If you are not using English, select the desired language from the Language drop-

down menu. To add a new language to the switch or update a current one, refer to the Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language section.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Getting Started
Starting the Web-based Switch Configuration Utility

STEP 3 If this is the first time that you logged on with the default user ID (cisco) and the

default password (cisco) or your password has expired, the Change Password Page appears. See Password Expiration for additional information.
STEP 4 Choose whether to select Disable Password Complexity Enforcement or not.

For more information on password complexity, see the Setting Password Complexity Rules section.
STEP 5 Enter the new password and click Apply.

When the login attempt is successful, the Getting Started page appears. If you entered an incorrect username or password, an error message appears and the Login page remains displayed on the window. Select Dont show this page on startup to prevent the Getting Started page from being displayed each time that you log on to the system. If you select this option, the System Summary page is opened instead of the Getting Started page.

HTTP/HTTPS
You can either open an HTTP session (not secured) by clicking Log In, or you can open an HTTPS (secured) session, by clicking Secure Browsing (HTTPS). You are asked to approve the logon with a default RSA key, and an HTTPS session is opened.
NOTE There is no need to input the username/password prior to clicking the Secure

Browsing (HTTPS) button. For information on how to configure HTTPS, see SSL Server Authentication Settings.

Password Expiration
The New Password page appears: The first time you access the switch with the default username cisco and password cisco. This page forces you to replace the factory default password. When the password expires, this page forces you to select a new password.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Getting Started
Starting the Web-based Switch Configuration Utility

Logging Out
By default, the application logs out after ten minutes of inactivity. You can change this default value as described in the Defining Idle Session Timeout section in the General Administrative Information and Operations chapter.

!
CAUTION Unless the Running Configuration is copied to the Startup Configuration, rebooting

the switch will remove all changes made since the last time the file was saved. Save the Running Configuration to the Startup Configuration before logging off to preserve any changes you made during this session. A flashing red X icon to the left of the Save application link indicates that Running Configuration changes have not yet been saved to the Startup Configuration file. The flashing can be disabled by clicking on the Disable Save Icon Blinking button on the Copy/Save Configuration page When the switch auto-discovers a device, such as an IP phone (see What is a Smartport), and it configures the port appropriately for the device. These configuration commands are written to the Running Configuration file. This causes the Save icon to begin blinking when the you log on even though you did not make any configuration changes. When you click Save, the Copy/Save Configuration page appears. Save the Running Configuration file by copying it to the Startup Configuration file. After this save, the red X icon and the Save application link are no longer displayed. To logout, click Logout in the top right corner of any page. The system logs out of the switch. When a timeout occurs or you intentionally log out of the system, a message appears and the Login page appears, with a message indicating the logged-out state. After you log in, the application returns to the initial page. The initial page displayed depends on the Do not show this page on startup option in the Getting Started page. If you did not select this option, the initial page is the Getting Started page. If you did select this option, the initial page is the System Summary page.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

1
Quick Start Switch Configuration

Getting Started
Quick Start Switch Configuration

To simplify switch configuration through quick navigation, the Getting Started page provides links to the most commonly used pages.

Links on the Getting Started page Category Link Name (on the Page) Change Management Applications and Services Change Device IP Address Create VLAN Configure Port Settings Device Status System Summary Port Statistics RMON Statistics View Log Quick Access Change Device Password Upgrade Device Software Backup Device Configuration Configure QoS Configure Port Mirroring Linked Page TCP/UDP Services page IPv4 Interface page Create VLAN page Port Setting page System Summary page Interface page Statistics page RAM Memory page User Accounts page Upgrade/Backup Firmware/ Language page Download/Backup Configuration/Log page QoS Properties page Port and VLAN Mirroring page

There are two hot links on the Getting Started page that take you to Cisco web pages for more information. Clicking on the Support link takes you to the switch product support page, and clicking on the Forums link takes you to the Small Business Support Community page.

Interface Naming Conventions


Within the GUI, interfaces are denoted by concatenating the following elements:

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Getting Started
Interface Naming Conventions

1
Type of interface: The following types of interfaces are found on the various types of devices: Fast Ethernet (10/100 bits)These are displayed as FE. Gigabit Ethernet ports (10/100/1000 bits)These are displayed as GE. LAG (Port Channel)These are displayed as LAG. VLANThese are displayed as VLAN. Tunnel These are displayed as Tunnel.

Interface Number: Port, LAG, tunnel or VLAN ID

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

1
Window Navigation

Getting Started
Window Navigation

This section describes the features of the web-based configuration utility.

Application Header
The Application Header appears on every page. It provides the following application links:

Application Links Application Link Name Description A flashing red X icon displayed to the left of the Save application link indicates that Running Configuration changes have been made that have not yet been saved to the Startup Configuration file. The flashing of the red X can be disabled on the Copy/Save Configuration page. Click Save to display the Copy/Save Configuration page. Save the Running Configuration file by copying it to the Startup Configuration file type on the switch. After this save, the red X icon and the Save application link are no longer displayed. When the switch is rebooted, it copies the Startup Configuration file type to the Running Configuration and sets the switch parameters according to the data in the Running Configuration. Username Displays the name of the user logged on to the switch. The default username is cisco. (The default password is cisco).

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Getting Started
Window Navigation

1
Application Links (Continued) Application Link Name Language Menu Description This menu provides the following options: Select a language: Select one of the languages that appear in the menu. This language will be the webbased configuration utility language. Download Language: Add a new language to the switch. Delete Language: Deletes the second language on the switch. The first language (English) cannot be deleted. Debug: Used for translation purposes. If you select this option, all web-based configuration utility labels disappear and in their place are the IDs of the strings that correspond to the IDs in the language file.
NOTE To upgrade a language file, use the Upgrade/

Backup Firmware/Language page. Logout About Help Click to log out of the web-based configuration utility. Click to display the switch name and switch version number. Click to display the online help. The SYSLOG Alert Status icon appears when a SYSLOG message, above the critical severity level, is logged. Click the icon to open the RAM Memory page. After you access this page, the SYSLOG Alert Status icon is no longer displayed. To display the page when there is not an active SYSLOG message, Click Status and Statistics > View Log > RAM Memory.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

1
Management Buttons

Getting Started
Window Navigation

The following table describes the commonly-used buttons that appear on various pages in the system.

Management Buttons Button Name Description Use the pull-down menu to configure the number of entries per page. Indicates a mandatory field.

Add

Click to display the related Add page and add an entry to a table. Enter the information and click Apply to save it to the Running Configuration. Click Close to return to the main page. Click Save to display the Copy/Save Configuration page and save the Running Configuration to the Startup Configuration file type on the switch. Click to apply changes to the Running Configuration on the switch. If the switch is rebooted, the Running Configuration is lost, unless it is saved to the Startup Configuration file type or another file type. Click Save to display the Copy/ Save Configuration page and save the Running Configuration to the Startup Configuration file type on the switch. Click to reset changes made on the page. Click to clear the statistic counters for all interfaces.

Apply

Cancel Clear All Interfaces Counters Clear Interface Counters Clear Logs Clear Table Close

Click to clear the statistic counters for the selected interface. Clears log files. Clears table entries. Returns to main page. If any changes were not applied to the Running Configuration, a message appears.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Getting Started
Window Navigation

1
Management Buttons (Continued) Button Name Copy Settings Description A table typically contains one or more entries containing configuration settings. Instead of modifying each entry individually, it is possible to modify one entry and then copy the selected entry to multiple entries, as described below: 1. Select the entry to be copied. Click Copy Settings to display the popup. 2. Enter the destination entry numbers in the to field. 3. Click Apply to save the changes and click Close to return to the main page. Delete Details Edit After selecting an entry in the table, click Delete to remove. Click to display the details associated with the entry selected. Select the entry and click Edit . The Edit page appears, and the entry can be modified. 1. Click Apply to save the changes to the Running Configuration. 2. Click Close to return to the main page. Go Test Enter the query filtering criteria and click Go. The results are displayed on the page. Click Test to perform the related tests.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

10

2
Statistics and Statistics
This section describes how to view switch statistics. It covers the following topics: Viewing Ethernet Interfaces Viewing Etherlike Statistics Viewing 802.1X EAP Statistics Managing RMON

Viewing Ethernet Interfaces


The Interface page displays traffic statistics per port. The refresh rate of the information can be selected. This page is useful for analyzing the amount of traffic that is both sent and received and its dispersion (Unicast, Multicast, and Broadcast). To display Ethernet statistics and/or set the refresh rate:
STEP 1 Click Status and Statistics > Interface. The Interface page appears. STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

InterfaceSelect the type of interface and specific interface for which Ethernet statistics are to be displayed. Refresh RateSelect the time period that passes before the interface Ethernet statistics are refreshed. The available options are: No RefreshStatistics are not refreshed. 15 SecStatistics are refreshed every 15 seconds. 30 SecStatistics are refreshed every 30 seconds.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

11

Statistics and Statistics


Viewing Etherlike Statistics

2
60 SecStatistics are refreshed every 60 seconds. The Receive Statistics area displays information about incoming packets. Total Bytes (Octets)Octets received, including bad packets and FCS octets, but excluding framing bits. Unicast PacketsGood Unicast packets received. Multicast PacketsGood Multicast packets received. Broadcast PacketsGood Broadcast packets received. Packets with ErrorsPackets with errors received.

The Transmit Statistics area displays information about outgoing packets. Total Bytes (Octets)Octets transmitted, including bad packets and FCS octets, but excluding framing bits. Unicast PacketsGood Unicast packets transmitted. Multicast PacketsGood Multicast packets transmitted. Broadcast PacketsGood Broadcast packets transmitted.

To clear statistics counters: Click Clear Interface Counters to clear counters for the interface displayed. Click Clear All Interface Counters to clear counters for all interfaces.

Viewing Etherlike Statistics


The Etherlike page displays statistics per port according to the Etherlike MIB standard definition. The refresh rate of the information can be selected. This page provides more detailed information regarding errors in the physical layer (Layer 1), which might disrupt traffic. To view Etherlike Statistics and/or set the refresh rate:
STEP 1 Click Status and Statistics > Etherlike. The Etherlike page appears. STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

12

Statistics and Statistics


Viewing 802.1X EAP Statistics

InterfaceSelect the type of interface and specific interface for which Ethernet statistics are to be displayed. Refresh RateSelect the amount of time that passes before the Etherlike statistics are refreshed.

The fields are displayed for the selected interface. Frame Check Sequence (FCS) ErrorsReceived frames that failed the CRC (cyclic redundancy checks). Single Collision FramesFrames that were involved in a single collision, but were successfully transmitted. Late CollisionsCollisions that have been detected after the first 512 bits of data. Excessive CollisionsNumber of transmissions rejected due to excessive collisions. Oversize PacketsPackets greater than 2000 octets received. Internal MAC Receive ErrorsFrames rejected because of receiver errors. Pause Frames ReceivedReceived flow control pause frames. Pause Frames TransmittedFlow control pause frames transmitted from the selected interface.

To clear statistics counters: Click Clear Interface Counters to clear the selected interfaces counters. Click Clear All Interface Counters to clear the counters of all interfaces.

Viewing 802.1X EAP Statistics


The 802.1x EAP page displays detailed information regarding the EAP (Extensible Authentication Protocol) frames that were sent or received. To configure the 802.1X feature, see the 802.1X Properties page. To view the EAP Statistics and/or set the refresh rate:

13

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Statistics and Statistics


Viewing 802.1X EAP Statistics

STEP 1 Click Status and Statistics > 802.1x EAP . The 802.1x EAP page appears. STEP 2 Select the Interface that is polled for statistics. STEP 3 Select the time period (Refresh Rate) that passes before the EAP statistics are

refreshed. The values are displayed for the selected interface. EAPOL Frames ReceivedValid EAPOL frames received on the port. EAPOL Frames TransmittedValid EAPOL frames transmitted by the port. EAPOL Start Frames ReceivedEAPOL Start frames received on the port. EAPOL Logoff Frames ReceivedEAPOL Logoff frames received on the port. EAP Response/ID Frames ReceivedEAP Resp/ID frames received on the port. EAP Response Frames ReceivedEAP Response frames received by the port (other than Resp/ID frames). EAP Request/ID Frames TransmittedEAP Req/ID frames transmitted by the port. EAP Request Frames TransmittedEAP Request frames transmitted by the port. Invalid EAPOL Frames ReceivedUnrecognized EAPOL frames received on this port. EAP Length Error Frames ReceivedEAPOL frames with an invalid Packet Body Length received on this port. Last EAPOL Frame VersionProtocol version number attached to the most recently received EAPOL frame. Last EAPOL Frame SourceSource MAC address attached to the most recently received EAPOL frame.

To clear statistics counters: Click Clear Interface Counters to clear the selected interfaces counters. Click Clear All Interface Counters to clear the counters of all interfaces.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

14

2
Managing RMON

Statistics and Statistics


Managing RMON

RMON (Remote Networking Monitoring) enables the switch to proactively monitor traffic statistics over a given period. With this feature, you can view the current statistics (since the counter values were cleared).

Viewing RMON Statistics


The Statistics page displays detailed information regarding packet sizes and information regarding physical layer errors. The information displayed is according to the RMON standard. An oversized packet is defined as an Ethernet frame with the following criteria: Packet length is greater than MRU byte size. Collision event has not been detected. Late collision event has not been detected. Received (Rx) error event has not been detected. Packet has a valid CRC.

To view RMON statistics and/or set the refresh rate:


STEP 1 Click Status and Statistics > RMON > Statistics. The Statistics page appears. STEP 2 Select the Interface for which Ethernet statistics are to be displayed. STEP 3 Select the Refresh Rate, the time period that passes before the interface

statistics are refreshed. The statistics are displayed for the selected interface. Bytes ReceivedNumber of octets received, including bad packets and FCS octets, but excluding framing bits. Drop EventsNumber of packets dropped. Packets ReceivedNumber of good packets received, including Multicast and Broadcast packets. Broadcast Packets ReceivedNumber of good Broadcast packets received. This number does not include Multicast packets.

15

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Statistics and Statistics


Managing RMON

2
Multicast Packets ReceivedNumber of good Multicast packets received. CRC & Align ErrorsNumber of CRC and Align errors that have occurred. Undersize PacketsNumber of undersized packets (less than 64 octets) received. Oversize PacketsNumber of oversized packets (over 2000 octets) received. FragmentsNumber of fragments (packets with less than 64 octets, excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) received. JabbersTotal number received packets that were longer than 1632 octets. This number excludes frame bits, but includes FCS octets that had either a bad FCS (Frame Check Sequence) with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral octet (Alignment Error) number. A Jabber packet is defined as an Ethernet frame that satisfies the following criteria: Packet data length is greater than MRU. Packet has an invalid CRC. Received (Rx) Error Event has not been detected.

CollisionsNumber of collisions received. If Jumbo Frames are enabled, the threshold of Jabber Frames is raised to the maximum size of Jumbo Frames. Frames of 64 BytesNumber of frames, containing 64 bytes that were received. Frames of 65 to 127 BytesNumber of frames, containing 65-127 bytes that were received. Frames of 128 to 255 BytesNumber of frames, containing 128-255 bytes that were received. Frames of 256 to 511 BytesNumber of frames, containing 256-511 bytes that were received. Frames of 512 to 1023 BytesNumber of frames, containing 512-1023 bytes that were received. Frames greater than 1024 BytesNumber of frames, containing 10242000 bytes, and Jumbo Frames, that were received.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

16

2
To clear statistics counters:

Statistics and Statistics


Managing RMON

Click Clear Interface Counters to clear the selected interfaces counters. Click Clear All Interface Counters to clear the counters of all interfaces.

17

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Statistics and Statistics


Managing RMON

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

18

3
Administration: System Log
This section describes the System Log feature, which enables the switch to generate several independent logs. Each log is a set of messages describing system events. The switch generates the following local logs: Log sent to the console interface. Log written into a cyclical list of logged events in the RAM and erased when the switch reboots. Log written to a cyclical log-file saved to the Flash memory and persists across reboots.

In addition, you can send messages to remote SYSLOG servers in the form of SYSLOG messages. This section covers the following sections: Setting System Log Settings Setting Remote Logging Settings Viewing Memory Logs

Setting System Log Settings


You can enable or disable logging on the Log Settings page, and select whether to aggregate log messages. You can select the events by severity level. Each log message has a severity level marked with the first letter of the severity level concatenated with a dash (-) on each side (except for Emergency that is indicated by the letter F). For example, the log message "%INIT-I-InitCompleted: " has a severity level of I, meaning Informational.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

19

Administration: System Log


Setting System Log Settings

3
EmergencySystem is not usable. AlertAction is needed. CriticalSystem is in a critical condition. ErrorSystem is in error condition. WarningSystem warning has occurred. NoticeSystem is functioning properly, but a system notice has occurred. InformationalDevice information. DebugDetailed information about an event.

The event severity levels are listed from the highest severity to the lowest severity, as follows:

You can select different severity levels for RAM and Flash logs. These logs are displayed in the RAM Memory page and Flash Memory page, respectively. Selecting a severity level to be stored in a log causes all of the higher severity events to be automatically stored in the log. Lower severity events are not stored in the log. For example, if Warning is selected, all severity levels that are Warning and higher are stored in the log (Emergency, Alert, Critical, Error, and Warning). No events with severity level below Warning are stored (Notice, Informational, and Debug). To set global log parameters:
STEP 1 Click Administration > System Log > Log Settings. The Log Settings page

appears.
STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

LoggingSelect to enable message logging. Syslog AggregatorSelect to enable the aggregation of SYSLOG messages and traps. If enabled, identical and contiguous SYSLOG messages and traps are aggregated over the specified Max Aggregation Time and sent in a single message. The aggregated messages are sent in the order of their arrival. Each message states the number of times it was aggregated. Max Aggregation TimeEnter the interval of time that SYSLOG messages are aggregated.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

20

Administration: System Log


Setting Remote Logging Settings

RAM Memory LoggingSelect the severity levels of the messages to be logged to the RAM. Flash Memory LoggingSelect the severity levels of the messages to be logged to the Flash memory.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

Setting Remote Logging Settings


The Remote Log Servers page enables defining remote SYSLOG servers where log messages are sent (using the SYSLOG protocol). For each server, you can configure the severity of the messages that it receives. To define SYSLOG servers:
STEP 1 Click Administration > System Log > Remote Log Servers. The Remote Log

Servers page appears. This page contains the list of remote log servers.
STEP 2 Click Add. The Add Remote Log Server page appears. STEP 3 Enter the parameters.

Server DefinitionSelect whether to identify the remote log server by IP address or name. IP VersionSelect the supported IP format. IPv6 Address TypeSelect the IPv6 address type (if IPv6 is used). The options are: Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

Link Local InterfaceSelect the link local interface (if IPv6 Address Type Link Local is selected) from the list.

21

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: System Log


Viewing Memory Logs

3
Log Server IP Address/NameEnter the IP address or domain name of the log server. UDP PortEnter the UDP port to which the log messages are sent. FacilitySelect a facility value from which system logs are sent to the remote server. Only one facility value can be assigned to a server. If a second facility code is assigned, the first facility value is overridden. DescriptionEnter a server description. Minimum SeveritySelect the minimum level of system log messages to be sent to the server.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The Add Remote Log Server page closes, the SYSLOG server is

added, and the Running Configuration file is updated.

Viewing Memory Logs


The switch can write to the following logs: Log in RAM (cleared during reboot). Log in Flash memory (cleared only upon user command).

You can configure the messages that are written to each log by severity, and a message can go to more than one log, including logs that reside on external SYSLOG servers.

RAM Memory
The RAM Memory page displays all messages that were saved in the RAM (cache) in chronological order. Entries are stored in the RAM log according to the configuration in the Log Settings page. To view log entries, click Status and Statistics > View Log > RAM Memory. The RAM Memory page appears. The top of the page has a button that allows you to Disable Alert Icon Blinking. Click to toggle between disable and enable. This page contains the following fields:

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

22

3
Log IndexLog entry number. SeverityEvent severity.

Administration: System Log


Viewing Memory Logs

Log TimeTime when message was generated.

DescriptionMessage text describing the event.

To clear the log messages, click Clear Logs. The messages are cleared.

Flash Memory
The Flash Memory page displays the messages that were stored in the Flash memory, in chronological order. The minimum severity for logging is configured in the Log Settings page. Flash logs remain when the switch is rebooted. You can clear the logs manually. To view the Flash logs, click Status and Statistics > View Log > Flash Memory. The Flash Memory page appears. This page contains the following fields: Log IndexLog entry number. Log TimeTime when message was generated. SeverityEvent severity. DescriptionMessage text describing the event.

To clear the messages, click Clear Logs. The messages are cleared.

23

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: System Log


Viewing Memory Logs

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

24

4
Administration: File Management
This section describes how system files are managed. The following topics are covered: Types of System Files Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language Downloading or Backing-up a Configuration or Log Viewing Configuration Files Properties Copying Configuration Files DHCP Auto Configuration

Types of System Files


System files are files that contain configuration information, firmware images or boot code. Various actions can be performed with these files, such as: selecting the firmware file from which the switch boots, copying various types of configuration files internally on the switch, or copying files to or from an external device, such as an external server. The possible methods of file transfer are: Internal copy. HTTP/HTTPS that uses the facilities that the browser provides. TFTP client, requiring a TFTP server.

Configuration files on the switch are defined by their type, and contain the settings and parameter values for the device.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

25

Administration: File Management


Types of System Files

When a configuration is referenced on the switch, it is referenced by its configuration file type (such as Startup Configuration or Running Configuration), as opposed to a file name that can be modified by the user. Content can be copied from one configuration file type to another, but the names of the file types cannot be changed by the user. Other files on the device include firmware, boot code, and log files, and are referred to as operational files. The configuration files are text files and can be edited in a text editor, such as Notepad after they are copied to an external device, such as a PC. Files and File Types The following types of configuration and operational files are found on the switch: Running ConfigurationContains the parameters currently being used by the switch to operate. This is the only file type that is modified when you change parameter values on the device. If the switch is rebooted, the Running Configuration is lost. The Startup Configuration, stored in Flash, overwrites the Running Configuration, stored in RAM. To preserve any changes you made to the switch, you must save the Running Configuration to the Startup Configuration, or another file type. Startup ConfigurationThe parameter values that were saved by copying another configuration (usually the Running Configuration) to the Startup Configuration. The Startup Configuration is retained in Flash and is preserved when the switch is rebooted. At this time, the Startup Configuration is copied to RAM and identified as the Running Configuration. Mirror ConfigurationA copy of the Startup Configuration, created by the switch when the following conditions exist: The switch has been operating continuously for 24 hours. No configuration changes have been made to the Running Configuration in the previous 24 hours. The Startup Configuration is identical to the Running Configuration.

Only the system can copy the Startup Configuration to the Mirror Configuration. However, you can copy from the Mirror Configuration to other file types or to another device.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

26

Administration: File Management


Types of System Files

The option of automatically copying the Running Configuration to the mirror configuration can be disabled in the Configuration Files Properties page. Backup ConfigurationA manual copy of a configuration file used for protection against system shutdown or for the maintenance of a specific operating state. You can copy the Mirror Configuration, Startup Configuration, or Running Configuration to a Backup Configuration file. The Backup Configuration exists in Flash and is preserved if the device is rebooted. FirmwareThe program that controls the operations and functionality of the switch. More commonly referred to as the image. Boot CodeControls the basic system startup and launches the firmware image. Language FileThe dictionary that enables the web-based configuration utility windows to be displayed in the selected language. Flash LogSYSLOG messages stored in Flash memory.

File Actions The following actions can be performed to manage firmware and configuration files: Upgrade the firmware or boot code, or replace a second language, as described in Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language section. Save configuration files on the switch to a location on another device as described in the Downloading or Backing-up a Configuration or Log section. Clear the Startup Configuration or Backup Configuration file types as described in the Viewing Configuration Files Properties section. Copy one configuration file type to another configuration file type as described in the Copying Configuration Files section. Enable automatically uploading a configuration file from a DHCP server to the switch, as described in the DHCP Auto Configuration section.

This section covers the following topics: Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language Downloading or Backing-up a Configuration or Log Viewing Configuration Files Properties

27

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: File Management


Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language

Copying Configuration Files DHCP Auto Configuration

Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language
The Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language process can be used to: Upgrade or backup the firmware image. Upgrade or backup the boot code. Import or upgrade a second language file.

The following methods for transferring files are supported: HTTP/HTTPS that uses the facilities provided by the browser TFTP that requires a TFTP server

If a new language file was loaded onto the switch, the new language can be selected from the drop-down menu. (It is not necessary to reboot the switch). A single firmware image is stored on the switch. After new firmware has been successfully loaded into the switch, the device needs to be rebooted prior to the new firmware taking effect. The Summary page continues to show the previous image prior to the reboot.

Upgrading/Backing Up Firmware or Language File


To upgrade or backup a software image or language file:
STEP 1 Click Administration > File Management > Upgrade/Backup Firmware/

Language. The Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language page appears.


STEP 2 Click the Transfer Method. Proceed as follows:

If you selected TFTP, go to STEP 3. If you selected via HTTP/HTTPS, go to STEP 4.

STEP 3 If you selected via TFTP, enter the parameters as described in this step.

Otherwise, skip to STEP 4.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

28

4
Select one of the following actions:

Administration: File Management


Upgrade/Backup Firmware/Language

Upgrade Save ActionSpecifies that the file type on the switch is to be replaced with a new version of that file type located on a TFTP server. Backup Save ActionSpecifies that a copy of the file type is to be saved to a file on another device.

Enter the following fields: File TypeSelect the destination file type. Only valid file types are shown. (The file types are described in the Files and File Types section). TFTP Server DefinitionSelect whether to specify the TFTP server by IP address or domain name. IP VersionSelect whether an IPv4 or an IPv6 address is used. IPv6 Address TypeSelect the IPv6 address type (if IPv6 is used). The options are: Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

Link Local InterfaceSelect the link local interface (if IPv6 is used) from the list. TFTP Server IP Address/NameEnter the IP address or the domain name of the TFTP server. (For Upgrade) Source File NameEnter the name of the source file. (For Backup) Destination File NameEnter the name of the backup file.

STEP 4 If you selected via HTTP/HTTPS, you can only Upgrade. Enter the parameters as

described in this step. File TypeSelect the configuration file type. Only valid file types can be selected. (The file types are described in the Files and File Types section). The following file types can be upgraded: 29

Firmware ImageSelect this to upgrade the firmware image. LanguageSelect this to upgrade the language file.
Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: File Management


Downloading or Backing-up a Configuration or Log

File NameClick Browse to select a file or enter the path and source file name to be used in the transfer.

STEP 5 Click Apply or Done. The file is upgraded or backed up.

Downloading or Backing-up a Configuration or Log


The Download/Backup Configuration/Log page enables
NOTE

Backing up configuration files or logs from to switch to an external device. Restoring configuration files from an external device to the switch.

When restoring a configuration file to the Running Configuration, the imported file adds any configuration commands that did not exist in the old file and overwrites any parameter values in the existing configuration commands. When restoring a configuration file to the Startup Configuration or a backup configuration file, the new file replaces the previous file. When restoring to Startup Configuration, the switch must be rebooted for the restored Startup Configuration to be used as the Running Configuration. You can reboot the switch by using the process described in the Rebooting the Switch section. To backup or restore the system configuration file:
STEP 1 Click Administration > File Management > Download/Backup Configuration/

Log. The Download/Backup Configuration/Log page appears.


STEP 2 Select the Transfer Method. STEP 3 If you selected via TFTP , enter the parameters. Otherwise, skip to STEP 4.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

30

Administration: File Management


Downloading or Backing-up a Configuration or Log

Select either Download or Backup as the Save Action. Download Save ActionSpecifies that the file on another device replaces a file type on the switch. Enter the following fields: a. Server DefinitionSelect whether to specify the TFTP server by IP address or by domain name. b. IP VersionSelect whether an IPv4 or an IPv6 address is used.
NOTE If the server is selected by name in the Server Definition, there is no

need to select the IP Version related options. c. IPv6 Address TypeSelect the IPv6 address type (if used). The options are: Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

d. Link-Local InterfaceSelect the link local interface from the list. e. TFTP ServerEnter the IP address of the TFTP server. f. Source File NameEnter the source file name. File names cannot contain slashes (\ or /), cannot start with a period (.), and must include between 1 and 160 characters. (Valid characters: A-Z, a-z, 0-9, ., -, _).

g. Destination File TypeEnter the destination configuration file type. Only valid file types are displayed. (The file types are described in the Files and File Types section). Backup Save ActionSpecifies that a file type is to be copied to a file on another device. Enter the following fields: a. Server DefinitionSelect whether to specify the TFTP server by IP address or by domain name. b. IP VersionSelect whether an IPv4 or an IPv6 address is used. c. IPv6 Address TypeSelect the IPv6 address type (if used). The options are:

31

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: File Management


Downloading or Backing-up a Configuration or Log

Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

d. Link-Local InterfaceSelect the link local interface from the list. e. TFTP Server IP Address/NameEnter the IP address or domain name of the TFTP server. f. Source File TypeEnter the source configuration file type. Only valid file types are displayed. (The file types are described in the Files and File Types section).

g. Sensitive DataSelect how sensitive data should be included in the backup file. The following options are available: ExcludeDo not include sensitive data in the backup. EncryptedInclude sensitive data in the backup in its encrypted form. PlaintextInclude sensitive data in the backup in its plaintext form.

NOTE The available sensitive data options are determined by the current user SSD rules. For details, refer to Secure Sensitive Data Management > SSD Rules page.

h. Destination File NameEnter the destination file name. File names cannot contain slashes (\ or /), the leading letter of the file name must not be a period (.), and the file name must be between 1 and 160 characters. (Valid characters: A-Z, a-z, 0-9, ., -, _). i. Click Apply. The file is upgraded or backed up.

STEP 4 If you selected via HTTP/HTTPS, enter the parameters as described in this step.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

32

4
Select the Save Action.

Administration: File Management


Viewing Configuration Files Properties

If Save Action is Download (replacing the file on the switch with a new version from another device), do the following. Otherwise, go to the next procedure in this step. a. Source File NameClick Browse to select a file or enter the path and source file name to be used in the transfer. b. Destination File TypeSelect the configuration file type. Only valid file types are displayed. (The file types are described in the Files and File Types section). c. Click Apply. The file is transferred from the other device to the switch. If Save Action is Backup (copying a file to another device), do the following: a. Source File TypeSelect the configuration file type. Only valid file types are displayed. (The file types are described in the Files and File Types section). b. Sensitive DataSelect how sensitive data should be included in the backup file. The following options are available: ExcludeDo not include sensitive data in the backup. EncryptedInclude sensitive data in the backup in its encrypted form. PlaintextInclude sensitive data in the backup in its plaintext form.

NOTE The available sensitive data options are determined by the current

user SSD rules. For details, refer to Secure Sensitive Data Management > SSD Rules page. c. Click Apply. The file is upgraded or backed up.

Viewing Configuration Files Properties


The Configuration Files Properties page allows you to see when various system configuration files were created. It also enables deleting the Startup Configuration and Backup Configuration files. You cannot delete the other configuration file types.

33

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: File Management


Copying Configuration Files

To set whether mirror configuration files will be created, clear configuration files and see when configuration files were created:
STEP 1 Click Administration > File Management > Configuration Files Properties. The

Configuration Files Properties page appears.


STEP 2 If required, disable Auto Mirror Configuration. This disables the automatic

creation of mirror configuration files. When disabling this feature, the mirror configuration file, if it exists, is deleted. See Types of System Files for a description of mirror files and why you might not want to automatically create mirror configuration files.
STEP 3 If required, select either the Startup Configuration, Backup Configuration or both

and click Clear Files to delete these files. This page provides the following fields: Configuration File NameDisplays the type of file. Creation TimeDisplays the date and time that file was modified.

Copying Configuration Files


When you click Apply on any window, changes that you made to the switch configuration settings are stored only in the Running Configuration. To preserve the parameters in the Running Configuration, the Running Configuration must be copied to another configuration type or saved on another device.

!
CAUTION Unless the Running Configuration is copied to the Startup Configuration or another

configuration file, all changes made since the last time the file was copied are lost when the switch is rebooted.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

34

Administration: File Management


Copying Configuration Files

The following combinations of copying internal file types are allowed: From the Running Configuration to the Startup Configuration or Backup Configuration. From the Startup Configuration to the Running Configuration or Backup Configuration. From the Backup Configuration to the Running Configuration or Startup Configuration. From the Mirror Configuration to the Running Configuration, Startup Configuration or Backup Configuration.

To copy one type of configuration file to another type of configuration file:


STEP 1 Click Administration > File Management > Copy/Save Configuration. The Copy/

Save Configuration page appears.


STEP 2 Select the Source File Name to be copied. Only valid file types are displayed

(described in the Files and File Types section).


STEP 3 Select the Destination File Name to be overwritten by the source file.

If you are backing up a configuration file, select one of the following formats for the backup file. ExcludeSensitive data is not included in the backup file. EncryptedSensitive data is included in the backup file in encrypted form. PlaintextSensitive data is included in the backup file in plain text.

NOTE The available sensitive data options are determined by the current

user SSD rules. For details, refer to Secure Sensitive Data Management > SSD Rules page.
STEP 4 The Save Icon Blinking field indicates whether an icon blinks when there is

unsaved data. To disable/enable this feature, click Disable/Enable Save Icon Blinking.
STEP 5 Click Apply. The file is copied.

35

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: File Management


DHCP Auto Configuration

DHCP Auto Configuration


The switch supports DHCP auto configuration, which provides a means of passing configuration information (including the IP address of a TFTP server and a file name) to hosts on a TCP/IP network. Based on this protocol, the Auto Configuration feature enables a switch to download configuration files from a TFTP server. By default, the switch is enabled as a DHCP client when the Auto Configuration feature is enabled.

Triggering DHCP Auto Configuration


The Auto Configuration process is triggered in the following cases: After reboot when an IP address is allocated or renewed dynamically (using DHCP). Upon an explicit DHCP renewal request and if the switch and the server are configured to do so. Upon automatic renewal of the DHCP lease.

Server Name/Address
You can specify the IP address or the name of the TFTP server. This server is used if no server IP address was specified in the DHCP message. This DHCP message is the DHCP offer message coming from the DHCP server. Possible options are bootp options sname and siaddr and DHCP option 150 or option 66. This is an optional parameter.

Backup Configuration File Name


You can specify the backup configuration filename. This file is used if no filename was specified in the DHCP message. This is an optional parameter.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

36

4
Auto Configuration Process

Administration: File Management


DHCP Auto Configuration

When the Auto Configuration process is triggered, the following sequence of events occurs: The DHCP server is accessed to acquire the TFTP server IP address and configuration file name. These parameters are passed in the DHCP option parameters. If an IP address was not supplied by the DHCP server, the backup server address is used (if configured by the user). If the IP address was not supplied by the DHCP server and the backup TFTP server address parameter is empty then the Auto Configuration process is halted.
NOTE In the previous two bullets, the IP address refers to the IP address or

hostname of the TFTP server. If the configuration filename was supplied by the DHCP server, then the copy protocol (TFTP) is selected as described in DHCP Auto Configuration. If a configuration filename was not supplied by the DHCP server, the backup configuration file name is used. If the configuration filename was not supplied by the DHCP server and the backup configuration file name is empty, the Auto Configuration process is halted. The TFTP server is accessed to download the file from it. The download process is done only if the new configuration filename is different from the current configuration filename (even if the current configuration file is empty). A SYSLOG message is generated acknowledging that the Auto Configuration process is completed.

Configuring DHCP Auto Configuration


The DHCP Auto Configuration page is used to perform the following actions when the information is not provided in a DHCP message: Enable DHCP auto configuration feature. Specify the download protocol.

37

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: File Management


DHCP Auto Configuration

Configure the switch to receive configuration information from a specific file on a specific server.

Note the following regarding the DHCP auto configuration process: A configuration file that is placed on the TFTP server must match the form and format requirements of a supported configuration file. The form and format of the file are checked, but the validity of the configuration parameters is not checked prior to loading it to the Startup Configuration. To ensure that the device configuration functions as intended, due to allocation of different IP addresses with each DHCP renew cycle, it is recommended that IP addresses be bound to MAC addresses in the DHCP server table. This ensures that each device has its own reserved IP address and other relevant information.

To configure DHCP server auto configuration:


STEP 1 Click Administration > File Management > DHCP Auto Configuration. The DHCP

Auto Configuration page appears.


STEP 2 Enter the values.

Auto Configuration Via DHCPSelect this field to enable DHCP Auto Configuration. Backup Server DefinitionSelect By IP Address or By name to configure the TFTP server.

STEP 3 Enter the following optional information to be used if DHCP Auto Configuration is

not enabled, or if it is enabled, but no configuration file was received from the DHCP server. Backup Server IP Address/NameEnter the IP address or the name of the server to be used if no server IP address was specified in the DHCP message. Backup Configuration File NameEnter the path and file name of the file to be used if no configuration file name was specified in the DHCP message.

The window displays the following: Last Auto Configuration Server IP AddressDisplays the IP address of the TFTP server last used to perform auto configuration. Last Auto Configuration File NameDisplays the last file name used by the switch in auto configuration.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

38

Administration: File Management


DHCP Auto Configuration

NOTE The Last Auto Configuration File Name is compared with the

information received from a DHCP server when an IP address is received for the switch. If this value does not match, the switch transfers the configuration file from the server identified by the DHCP server into the Startup Configuration file, and initiates a reboot. If the values match, no action is taken.
STEP 4 Click Apply. The DHCP Auto Configuration feature is updated in the Running

Configuration.

39

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: File Management


DHCP Auto Configuration

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

40

5
Administration: General Information
This section describes how to view system information and configure various options on the switch. It covers the following topics: Switch Models System Information Rebooting the Switch Monitoring Fan Status Defining Idle Session Timeout Pinging a Host

Switch Models
All models can be fully managed through the web-based configuration utility.
NOTE The following port conventions are used:

GE is used for Gigabit Ethernet (10/100/1000) ports. FE is used for Fast Ethernet (10/100) ports.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

41

Administration: General Information


Switch Models

]The following table describes the various models, the number and type of ports on them and their PoE information. Smart Switch Models Model Name Product ID (PID) SLM2016T SLM2024T SLM2024PT Description of Ports on Device Power Dedicated to PoE No. of Ports that Support PoE

SG200-18 SG200-26 SG200-26P

16 GE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo ports 24 GE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo-ports 24 GE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo-ports 100W 12 ports FE1-FE6, FE13 - FE18

SG200-50 SG200-50P

SLM2048T SLM2048PT

48 GE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo-ports 48 GE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo-ports 180W 24 ports FE1-FE12, FE25 - FE36

SF200-24 SF200-24P

SLM224GT SLM224PT

24 FE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo-ports 24 FE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo-ports 100W 12 ports FE1- FE6, FE13 - FE18

SF200-48 SF200-48P

SLM248GT SLM248PT

48 FE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo-ports FE1-FE48, GE1-GE4. 48 FE ports + 2 GE special-purpose combo-ports 180W 24 ports FE1- FE12, FE25 - FE36

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

42

5
System Information

Administration: General Information


System Information

The System Summary page provides a graphic view of the switch, and displays switch status, hardware information, firmware version information, general PoE status, and other items.

Displaying the System Summary


To view system information, click Status and Statistics > System Summary. The System Summary page appears. The System Summary page contains system and hardware information. System Information: System DescriptionA description of the system. System LocationPhysical location of the switch. Click Edit to go the System Settings page to enter this information. System ContactName of a contact person. Click Edit to go the System Settings page to enter this information. Host NameName of the switch. Click Edit to go the System Settings page to enter this information. By default, the switch hostname is composed of the word switch concatenated with the three least significant bytes of the switch MAC address (the six furthest right hexadecimal digits). System UptimeTime that has elapsed since the last reboot. Current TimeCurrent system time. Base MAC AddressSwitch MAC address. Jumbo FramesJumbo frame support status. This support can be enabled or disabled by using the Port Settings page of the Port Management menu.
NOTE Jumbo frames support takes effect only after it is enabled, and after

the switch is rebooted. TCP/UDP Services Status: HTTP ServiceDisplays whether HTTP is enabled/disabled. HTTPS ServiceDisplays whether HTTPS is enabled/disabled.

43

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: General Information


System Information

Other Summary Information: Model DescriptionSwitch model description. Serial NumberSerial number. PID VIDPart number and version ID.

PoE Power Information: Maximum Available PoE Power (W)Maximum available power that can be delivered by the PoE. Total PoE Power Consumption (W)Total PoE power delivered to connected PoE devices. PoE Power ModePort Limit or Class Limit.

Configuring the System Settings


To enter system settings:
STEP 1 Click Administration > System Settings. The System Settings page appears. STEP 2 View or modify the system settings.

System DescriptionDisplays a description of the switch. System LocationEnter the location where the switch is physically located. System ContactEnter the name of a contact person. Host NameSelect the host name of this switch. This is used in the prompt of CLI commands: Use DefaultThe default hostname (System Name) of these switches is: switch123456, where 123456 represents the last three bytes of the switch MAC address in hex format. User DefinedEnter the hostname. Use only letters, digits, and hyphens. Host names cannot begin or end with a hyphen. No other symbols, punctuation characters, or blank spaces are permitted (as specified in RFC1033, 1034, 1035).

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

44

Administration: General Information


Rebooting the Switch

Custom Login Screen SettingsTo display text on the Login page, enter the text in the Login Banner text box. Click Preview to view the results.
NOTE When you define a login banner from the web-based configuration utility, it also activates the banner for the CLI interfaces (Console, Telnet, and SSH).

STEP 3 Click Apply to set the values in the Running Configuration file.

Rebooting the Switch


Some configuration changes, such as enabling jumbo frame support, require the system to be rebooted before they take effect. However, rebooting the switch deletes the Running Configuration, so it is critical that the Running Configuration is saved to the Startup Configuration before the switch is rebooted. Clicking Apply does not save the configuration to the Startup Configuration. For more information on files and file types, see the Types of System Files section in the Administration: File Management section. You can back up the configuration by using Administration > File Management > Copy/Save Configuration or clicking Save at the top of the window. You can also upload the configuration from a remote device. See the Downloading or Backingup a Configuration or Log section in the Administration: File Management section. There are cases when you might prefer to set the time of the reboot for some time in the future. This could happen for example in one of the following cases: You are performing actions on a remote device, and these actions might create loss of connectivity to the remote device. Pre-scheduling a reboot restores the working configuration and enables restoring the connectivity to the remote device. If these actions are successful, the delayed reboot can be cancelled. Reloading the device cause loss of connectivity in the network, thus by using delayed reboot, you can schedule the reboot to a time that is more convenient for the users (e.g. late night).

45

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: General Information


Rebooting the Switch

To reboot the switch:


STEP 1 Click Administration > Reboot . The Reboot page appears. STEP 2 Click one of the Reboot buttons to reboot the switch.

RebootReboots the switch. Since any unsaved information in the Running Configuration is discarded when the switch is rebooted, you must click Save in the upper-right corner of any window to preserve current configuration across the boot process. If the Save option is not displayed, the Running Configuration matches the Startup Configuration and no action is necessary. The following options are available: ImmediateReboot immediately. DateEnter the date (month/day) and time (hour and minutes) of the schedule reboot. This schedules a reload of the software to take place at the specified time (using a 24-hour clock). If you specify the month and day, the reload is scheduled to take place at the specified time and date. If you do not specify the month and day, the reload takes place at the specified time on the current day (if the specified time is later than the current time) or on the next day (if the specified time is earlier than the current time). Specifying 00:00 schedules the reload for midnight. The reload must take place within 24 days.
NOTE This option can only be used if the system time has either been set

manually or by SNTP. InReboot within the specified number of hours and minutes. The maximum amount of time that can pass is 24 days.

Reboot to Factory DefaultsReboots the switch by using the factory default configuration. This process erases the Startup Configuration file, and the backup configuration file. The mirror configuration file is not deleted when restoring to factory default.

Clear Startup Configuration FileCheck to clear the startup configuration on the switch for the next time it boots up.
NOTE Clearing the Startup Configuration File and Rebooting is not the same

as Rebooting to Factory Defaults. Rebooting to Factory Defaults is more intrusive.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

46

5
Monitoring Fan Status

Administration: General Information


Monitoring Fan Status

The Health page displays the switch fan status on all devices with fans. Depending on the model, there are one or more fans on a device. To view the switch health parameters, click Status and Statistics > Health. The Health page appears. The Health page displays the following fields: Fan StatusFan status. The following values are possible: OKFan is operating normally. FailFan is not operating correctly. N/AFan ID is not applicable for the specific model.

Fan Direction(On relevant devices) The direction that the fans are working in (for example: Front to Back).

Defining Idle Session Timeout


The Idle Session Timeout configures the time interval during which the HTTP session can remain idle before it times out and you must log in again to reestablish the session. HTTP Session Timeout HTTPS Session Timeout

To set the idle session timeout of an HTTP or HTTPS session:


STEP 1 Click Administration > Idle Session Timeout . The Idle Session Timeout page

appears.
STEP 2 Select the timeout for the each session from the corresponding list. The default

timeout value is 10 minutes.


STEP 3 Click Apply to set the configuration settings on the switch.

47

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: General Information


Pinging a Host

Pinging a Host
Ping is a utility used to test if a remote host can be reached and to measure the round-trip time for packets sent from the switch to a destination device. Ping operates by sending Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) echo request packets to the target host and waiting for an ICMP response, sometimes called a pong. It measures the round-trip time and records any packet loss. To ping a host:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Ping. The Ping page appears. STEP 2 Configure ping by entering the fields:

Host DefinitionSelect whether to specify hosts by their IP address or name. IP VersionIf the host is identified by its IP address, select either IPv4 or IPv6 to indicate that it will be entered in the selected format. IPv6 Address TypeSelect Link Local or Global as the type of IPv6 address to enter. Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

Link Local InterfaceIf the IPv6 address type is Link Local, select from where it is received. Host IP Address/NameAddress or host name of the device to be pinged. Whether this is an IP address or host name depends on the Host Definition. Ping IntervalLength of time the system waits between ping packets. Ping is repeated the number of times configured in the "Number of Pings" field, whether the ping succeeds or not. Choose to use the default interval or specify your own value. Number of PingsThe number of times the ping operation is performed. Choose to use the default or specify your own value.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

48

Administration: General Information


Pinging a Host

StatusDisplays whether the ping succeeded or failed.

STEP 3 Click Activate Ping to ping the host. The ping status appears and another

message is added to the list of messages, indicating the result of the ping operation.
STEP 4 View the results of ping in the Ping Counters and Status section of the page.

49

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: General Information


Pinging a Host

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

50

6
Administration: Time Settings
Synchronized system clocks provide a frame of reference between all devices on the network. Network time synchronization is critical because every aspect of managing, securing, planning, and debugging a network involves determining when events occur. Without synchronized clocks, accurately correlating log files between devices when tracking security breaches or network usage is impossible. Synchronized time also reduces confusion in shared file systems, as it is important for the modification times to be consistent, regardless of the machine on which the file systems reside. For these reasons, it is important that the time configured on all of the devices on the network is accurate.
NOTE The switch supports Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) and when enabled, the

switch dynamically synchronizes the switch time with time from an SNTP server. The switch operates only as an SNTP client, and cannot provide time services to other devices. This section describes the options for configuring the system time, time zone, and Daylight Savings Time (DST). It covers the following topics: System Time Options SNTP Modes Configuring System Time

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

51

Administration: Time Settings


System Time Options

System Time Options


System time can be set manually by the user, dynamically from an SNTP server, or synchronized from the PC running the GUI. If an SNTP server is chosen, the manual time settings are overwritten when communications with the server are established. As part of the boot process, the switch always configures the time, time zone, and DST. These parameters are obtained from the PC running the GUI, SNTP, values set manually, or if all else fails, from the factory defaults.

Time
The following methods are available for setting the system time on the switch: ManualYou must manually sets the time. From PCTime can be received from the PC by using browser information. The configuration of time from the computer is saved to the Running Configuration file. You must copy the Running Configuration to the Startup Configuration in order to enable the device to use the time from the computer after reboot. The time after reboot is set during the first WEB login to the device. When you configure this feature for the first time, if the time was not already set, the device sets the time from the PC. This method of setting time works with both HTTP and HTTPS connections. SNTPTime can be received from SNTP time servers. SNTP ensures accurate network time synchronization of the switch up to the millisecond by using an SNTP server for the clock source. When specifying an SNTP server, if choosing to identify it by hostname, three suggestions are given in the GUI: time-a.timefreq.bldrdoc.gov time-b.timefreq.bldrdoc.gov time-c.timefreq.bldrdoc.gov

After the time has been set by any of the above sources, it is not set again by the browser.
NOTE SNTP is the recommended method for time setting.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

52

6
Time Zone and Daylight Savings Time (DST)

Administration: Time Settings


SNTP Modes

The Time Zone and DST can be set on the switch in the following ways: Dynamic configuration of the switch through a DHCP server, where: Dynamic DST, when enabled and available, always takes precedence over the manual configuration of DST. If the server supplying the source parameters fails, or dynamic configuration is disabled by the user, the manual settings are used. Dynamic configuration of the time zone and DST continues after the IP address lease time has expired.

Manual configuration of the time zone and DST becomes the Operational time zone and DST, only if the dynamic configuration is disabled or fails.
NOTE The DHCP server must supply DHCP option 100 in order for dynamic time zone configuration to take place.

SNTP Modes
The switch can receive the system time from an SNTP server in one of the following ways: Client Broadcast Reception (passive mode) SNTP servers broadcast the time, and the switch listens to these broadcasts. When the switch is in this mode, there is no need to define a Unicast SNTP server. Client Broadcast Transmission (active mode)The switch, as an SNTP client, periodically requests SNTP time updates. This mode works in either of the following ways: SNTP Anycast Client ModeThe switch broadcasts time request packets to all SNTP servers in the subnet, and waits for a response. Unicast SNTP Server ModeThe switch sends Unicast queries to a list of manually-configured SNTP servers, and waits for a response.

The switch supports having all of the above modes active at the same time and selects the best system time received from an SNTP server, according to an algorithm based on the closest stratum (distance from the reference clock).

53

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Time Settings


Configuring System Time

Configuring System Time


Selecting Source of System Time
Use the System Time page to select the system time source. If the source is manual, you can enter the time here.

!
CAUTION If the system time is set manually and the switch is rebooted, the manual time

settings must be reentered. To define system time:


STEP 1 Click Administration> Time Settings > System Time. The System Time page

appears. The following fields are displayed: Actual Time (Static)System time on the device. This shows the DHCP time zone or the acronym for the user-defined time zone if these were defined. Last Synchronized ServerAddress, stratum and type of the SNTP server from which time was last taken.

STEP 2 Enter these parameters:

Clock Source SettingsSelect the source used to set the system clock. Main Clock Source (SNTP Servers)If you enable this, the system time is obtained from an SNTP server. To use this feature, you must also configure a connection to an SNTP server in the SNTP Interface Settings page. Optionally, enforce authentication of the SNTP sessions by using the SNTP Authentication page. Alternate Clock Source (PC via active HTTP/HTTPS sessions)Select to set the date and time from the configuring computer using the HTTP protocol.
NOTE The Clock Source Setting needs to be set to either of the above in

order for RIP MD5 authentication to work. This also helps features that associate with time, for example:

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

54

6
DateEnter the system date. Local TimeEnter the system time.

Administration: Time Settings


Configuring System Time

Manual SettingsSet the date and time manually. The local time is used when there is no alternate source of time, such as an SNTP server:

Time Zone SettingsThe local time is used via the DHCP server or Time Zone offset. Get Time Zone from DHCPSelect to enable dynamic configuration of the time zone and the DST from the DHCP server. Whether one or both of these parameters can be configured depends on the information found in the DHCP packet. If this option is enabled, you must also enable DHCP client on the switch. To do this, set the IP Address Type to Dynamic in the IPv4 Interface page.
NOTE The DHCP Client supports Option 100 providing dynamic time zone setting. The switch does not support DHCPv6 Client.

Time Zone from DHCPDisplays the acronym of the time zone configured from the DHCP server. This acronym appears in the Actual Time field Time Zone OffsetSelect the difference in hours between Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) and the local time. For example, the Time Zone Offset for Paris is GMT +1, while the Time Zone Offset for New York is GMT 5. Time Zone AcronymEnter a user-defined name that represents the time zone you have configured. This acronym appears in the Actual Time field.

Daylight Savings SettingsSelect how DST is defined: Daylight SavingsSelect to enable Daylight Saving Time. Time Set OffsetEnter the number of minutes offset from GMT ranging from 11440. The default is 60. Daylight Savings TypeClick one of the following: -

USADST is set according to the dates used in the USA. EuropeanDST is set according to the dates used by the European
Union and other countries that use this standard.

By DatesDST is set manually, typically for a country other than the USA or a European country. Enter the following parameters: RecurringDST occurs on the same date every year.

Selecting By Dates allows customization of the start and stop of DST:


55 Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Time Settings


Configuring System Time

6
FromDay and time that DST starts. ToDay and time that DST ends. Selecting Recurring allows different customization of the start and stop of DST:

FromDate when DST begins each year. -

DayDay of the week on which DST begins every year. WeekWeek within the month from which DST begins every year. MonthMonth of the year in which DST begins every year. TimeThe time at which DST begins every year.

ToDate when DST ends each year. For example, DST ends locally every fourth Friday in October at 5:00 am. The parameters are: -

DayDay of the week on which DST ends every year. WeekWeek within the month from which DST ends every year. MonthMonth of the year in which DST ends every year. TimeThe time at which DST ends every year.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The system time values are written to the Running Configuration file.

Adding a Unicast SNTP Server


Up to eight Unicast SNTP servers can be configured.
NOTE To specify a Unicast SNTP server by name, you must first configure DNS server(s)

on the switch (see Defining DNS Servers). In order to add a Unicast SNTP server, check the box to enable SNTP Client Unicast .

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

56

6
To add a Unicast SNTP server: appears.

Administration: Time Settings


Configuring System Time

STEP 1 Click Administration > Time Settings > SNTP Unicast . The SNTP Unicast page

This page contains the following information for each Unicast SNTP server: SNTP ServerSNTP server IP address. Up to eight SNTP servers can be defined. The preferred server, or hostname, is chosen according to its stratum level. Poll IntervalDisplays whether polling is enabled or disabled. Authentication Key IDKey Identification used to communicate between the SNTP server and switch. Stratum LevelDistance from the reference clock expressed as a numerical value. An SNTP server cannot be the primary server (stratum level 1) unless polling interval is enabled. StatusSNTP server status. The possible values are: UpSNTP server is currently operating normally. DownSNTP server is currently not available. UnknownSNTP server is currently being searched for by the switch.

In ProcessOccurs when the SNTP server has not fully trusted its own
time server (i.e. when first booting up the SNTP server).

Last ResponseDate and time of the last time a response was received from this SNTP server. OffsetThe estimated offset of the server's clock relative to the local clock, in milliseconds. The host determines the value of this offset using the algorithm described in RFC 2030. DelayThe estimated round-trip delay of the server's clock relative to the local clock over the network path between them, in milliseconds. The host determines the value of this delay using the algorithm described in RFC 2030.

STEP 2 To add a Unicast SNTP server, enable SNTP Client Unicast . STEP 3 Click Add to display the Add SNTP Server page. STEP 4 Enter the following parameters:

57

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Time Settings


Configuring System Time

6
Server DefinitionSelect if the SNTP server is going to be identified by its IP address or if you are going to select a well-known SNTP server by name from the list.
NOTE To specify a well-known SNTP server, the switch must be connected

to the Internet and configured with a DNS server or configured so that a DNS server is identified by using DHCP. (See Defining DNS Servers ) IP VersionSelect the version of the IP address: Version 6 or Version 4. IPv6 Address TypeSelect the IPv6 address type (if IPv6 is used). The options are Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

Link Local InterfaceSelect the link local interface (if IPv6 Address Type Link Local is selected) from the list. SNTP Server IP AddressEnter the SNTP server IP address. The format depends on which address type was selected. SNTP ServerSelect the name of the SNTP server from a list of well-known NTP servers. If other is chosen, enter name of SNTP server in the adjacent field. Poll IntervalSelect to enable polling of the SNTP server for system time information. All NTP servers that are registered for polling are polled, and the clock is selected from the server with the lowest stratum level (distance from the reference clock) that is reachable. The server with the lowest stratum is considered to be the primary server. The server with the next lowest stratum is a secondary server, and so forth. If the primary server is down, the switch polls all servers with the polling setting enabled, and selects a new primary server with the lowest stratum. AuthenticationSelect the check box to enable authentication. Authentication Key IDIf authentication is enabled, select the value of the key ID. (Create the authentication keys using the SNTP Authentication page.)

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

58

Administration: Time Settings


Configuring System Time

STEP 5 Click Apply. The STNP server is added, and you are returned to the main page.

Configuring the SNTP Mode


The switch can be in active and/or passive mode (see SNTP Modes for more information). To enable receiving SNTP packets from all servers on the subnet and/or to enable transmitting time requests to SNTP servers:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Time Settings > SNTP Multicast/Anycast . The SNTP

Multicast/Anycast page appears.


STEP 2 Select from the following options:

SNTP Multicast Client Mode (Client Broadcast Reception)Select to receive system time from any SNTP server on the subnet. SNTP Anycast Client Mode (Client Broadcast Transmission)Select to transmit SNTP Broadcast synchronization packets requesting system time information. If SNTP servers have been defined, the packets go to these servers; otherwise, the packets are transmitted to all SNTP servers on the subnet.

Select an interface and select the reception/transmission options.


STEP 3 Click Apply to save the settings to the Running Configuration file.

Defining SNTP Authentication


SNTP clients can authenticate responses by using HMAC-MD5. An SNTP server is associated with a key, which is used as input together with the response itself to the MD5 function; the result of the MD5 is also included in the response packet. The SNTP Authentication page enables configuration of the authentication keys that are used when communicating with an SNTP server that requires authentication. The authentication key is created on the SNTP server in a separate process that depends on the type of SNTP server you are using. Consult with the SNTP server system administrator for more information.

59

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Time Settings


Configuring System Time

Workflow
STEP 1 Enable authentication in the SNTP Authentication page. STEP 2 Create a key in the SNTP Authentication page. STEP 3 Associate this key with an SNTP server in the SNTP Unicast page.

To enable SNTP authentication and define keys:


STEP 1 Click Administration > Time Settings > SNTP Authentication. The SNTP

Authentication page appears.


STEP 2 Select SNTP Authentication to support authentication of an SNTP session

between the switch and an SNTP server.


STEP 3 Click Apply to update the switch. STEP 4 Click Add. The Add SNTP Authentication page appears. STEP 5 Enter the following parameters:

Authentication Key IDEnter the number used to identify this SNTP authentication key internally. Authentication KeyEnter the key used for authentication (up to eight characters). The SNTP server must send this key for the switch to synchronize to it. Trusted KeySelect to enable the switch to receive synchronization information only from a SNTP server by using this authentication key.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The SNTP Authentication parameters are written to the Running

Configuration file.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

60

7
Administration: Diagnostics
This section contains information for configuring port mirroring, running cable tests, and viewing device operational information. It covers the following topics: Testing Copper Ports Displaying Optical Module Status Configuring Port and VLAN Mirroring Viewing CPU Utilization and Secure Core Technology

Testing Copper Ports


The Copper Test page displays the results of integrated cable tests performed on copper cables by the Virtual Cable Tester (VCT). VCT performs two types of tests: Time Domain Reflectometry (TDR) technology tests the quality and characteristics of a copper cable attached to a port. Cables of up to 140 meters long can be tested. These results are displayed in the Test Results block of the Copper Test page. DSP-based tests are performed on active GE links to measure cable length. These results are displayed in the Advanced Information block of the Copper Test page.

Preconditions to Running the Copper Port Test


Before running the test, do the following: (Mandatory) Disable Short Reach mode (see the Port Management > Green Ethernet > Properties page)

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

61

Administration: Diagnostics
Testing Copper Ports

7
(Optional) Disable EEE (see the Port Management > Green Ethernet > Properties page)

Use a CAT5 data cable when testing cables using (VCT). Accuracy of the test results can have an error range of +/- 10 for Advanced Testing and +/- 2 for basic testing.

!
CAUTION When a port is tested, it is set to the Down state and communications are

interrupted. After the test, the port returns to the Up state. It is not recommended that you run the copper port test on a port you are using to run the web-based configuration utility, because communications with that device are disrupted. To test copper cables attached to ports:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Diagnostics > Copper Test . The Copper Test page

appears.
STEP 2 Select the port on which to run the test. STEP 3 Click Copper Test. STEP 4 When the message appears, click OK to confirm that the link can go down or

Cancel to abort the test. The following fields are displayed in the Test Results block: Last UpdateTime of the last test conducted on the port. Test ResultsCable test results. Possible values are: OKCable passed the test. No CableCable is not connected to the port. Open CableCable is connected on only one side. Short CableShort circuit has occurred in the cable. Unknown Test ResultError has occurred.

Distance to FaultDistance from the port to the location on the cable where the fault was discovered. Operational Port StatusDisplays whether port is up or down.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

62

Administration: Diagnostics
Displaying Optical Module Status

If the port being tested is a Giga port, the Advanced Information block contains the following information, which is refreshed each time you enter the page: Cable Length: Provides an estimate for the length. PairCable wire pair being tested. StatusWire pair status. Red indicates fault and Green indicates status OK. ChannelCable channel indicating whether the wires are straight or crossover. PolarityIndicates if automatic polarity detection and correction has been activated for the wire pair. Pair SkewDifference in delay between wire pairs.

NOTE TDR tests cannot be performed when the port speed is 10Mbit/Sec.

Displaying Optical Module Status


The Optical Module Status page displays the operating conditions reported by the SFP (Small Form-factor Pluggable) transceiver. Some information might not be available for SFPs that do not support the digital diagnostic monitoring standard SFF-8472.

MSA-compatible SFPs
The following FE SFP (100Mbps) transceivers are supported: MFEBX1: 100BASE-BX-20U SFP transceiver for single-mode fiber, 1310 nm wavelength, supports up to 20 km. MFEFX1: 100BASE-FX SFP transceiver, for multimode fiber, 1310 nm wavelength, supports up to 2 km. MFELX1: 100BASE-LX SFP transceiver, for single-mode fiber, 1310 nm wavelength, supports up to 10 km.

The following GE SFP (1000Mbps) transceivers are supported: MGBBX1: 1000BASE-BX-20U SFP transceiver, for single-mode fiber, 1310 nm wavelength, supports up to 40 km.

63

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Diagnostics
Configuring Port and VLAN Mirroring

MGBLH1: 1000BASE-LH SFP transceiver, for single-mode fiber, 1310 nm wavelength, supports up to 40 km. MGBLX1: 1000BASE-LX SFP transceiver, for single-mode fiber, 1310 nm wavelength, supports up to 10 km. MGBSX1:1000BASE-SX SFP transceiver, for multimode fiber, 850 nm wavelength, supports up to 550 m. MGBT1: 1000BASE-T SFP transceiver for category 5 copper wire, supports up to 100 m.

To view the results of optical tests, click Administration > Diagnostics > Optical Module Status. The Optical Module Status page appears. This page contains the following fields: PortPort number on which the SFP is connected. TemperatureTemperature (Celsius) at which the SFP is operating. VoltageSFPs operating voltage. CurrentSFPs current consumption. Output PowerTransmitted optical power. Input PowerReceived optical power. Transmitter FaultRemote SFP reports signal loss. Values are True, False, and No Signal (N/S). Loss of SignalLocal SFP reports signal loss. Values are True and False. Data ReadySFP is operational. Values are True and False

Configuring Port and VLAN Mirroring


Port mirroring is used on a network switch to send a copy of network packets seen on one switch port, multiple switch ports, or an entire VLAN to a network monitoring connection on another port on the switch. This is commonly used for network appliances that require monitoring of network traffic, such as an intrusiondetection system. A network analyzer connected to the monitoring port processes the data packets for diagnosing, debugging, and performance monitoring. Up to eight sources can be mirrored. This can be any combination of eight individual ports and/or VLANs.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

64

Administration: Diagnostics
Configuring Port and VLAN Mirroring

A packet that is received on a network port assigned to a VLAN that is subject to mirroring is mirrored to the analyzer port even if the packet was eventually trapped or discarded. Packets sent by the switch are mirrored when Transmit (Tx) mirroring is activated. Mirroring does not guarantee that all traffic from the source port(s) is received on the analyzer (destination) port. If more data is sent to the analyzer port than it can support, some data might be lost. Only one instance of mirroring is supported system-wide. The analyzer port (or target port for VLAN mirroring or port mirroring) is the same for all the mirrored VLANs or ports. To enable mirroring:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Diagnostics > Port and VLAN Mirroring. The Port and

VLAN Mirroring page appears. This page contains the following fields: Destination PortPort to which traffic is to be copied; the analyzer port. Source InterfaceInterface, port, or VLAN from which traffic is sent to the analyzer port. TypeType of monitoring: incoming to the port (Rx), outgoing from the port (Tx), or both. Status Displays one of the following values: ActiveBoth source and destination interfaces are up and forwarding traffic. Not ReadyEither source or destination (or both) are down or not forwarding traffic for some reason.

STEP 2 Click Add to add a port or VLAN to be mirrored. The Add Port and VLAN Mirroring

page appears.
STEP 3 Enter the parameters:

Destination PortSelect the analyzer port to where packets are copied. A network analyzer, such as a PC running Wireshark, is connected to this port. If a port is identified as an analyzer destination port, it remains the analyzer destination port until all entries are removed. Source InterfaceSelect the source port or source VLAN from where traffic is to be mirrored.

65

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Diagnostics
Viewing CPU Utilization and Secure Core Technology

TypeSelect whether incoming, outgoing, or both types of traffic are mirrored to the analyzer port. If Port is selected, the options are: Rx OnlyPort mirroring on incoming packets. Tx OnlyPort mirroring on outgoing packets. Tx and RxPort mirroring on both incoming and outgoing packets.

STEP 4 Click Apply. Port mirroring is added to the Running Configuration.

Viewing CPU Utilization and Secure Core Technology


This section describes the Secure Core Technology (SCT) and how to view CPU usage. The switch handles the following types of traffic, in addition to end-user traffic: Management traffic Protocol traffic Snooping traffic

Excessive traffic burdens the CPU, and might prevent normal switch operation. The switch uses the Secure Core Technology (SCT) feature to ensure that the switch receives and processes management and protocol traffic, no matter how much total traffic is received. SCT is enabled by default on the device and cannot be disabled. There are no interactions with other features.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

66

7
To display CPU utilization:

Administration: Diagnostics
Viewing CPU Utilization and Secure Core Technology

STEP 1 Click Administration > Diagnostics > CPU Utilization.

The CPU Utilization page appears. The CPU Input Rate field displays the rate of input frames to the CPU per second. The window contains a graph of the CPU utilization. The Y axis is percentage of usage, and the X axis is the sample number.
STEP 2 Select the Refresh Rate (time period in seconds) that passes before the statistics

are refreshed. A new sample is created for each time period.

67

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Diagnostics
Viewing CPU Utilization and Secure Core Technology

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

68

8
Administration: Discovery
This section provides information for configuring Discovery. It covers the following topics: Configuring Bonjour Discovery LLDP and CDP Configuring LLDP Configuring CDP

Configuring Bonjour Discovery


As a Bonjour client, the switch periodically broadcasts Bonjour Discovery protocol packets to directly-connected IP subnet(s), advertising its existence and the services that it provides, for example; HTTP or HTTPS. (Use the Security > TCP/ UDP Services page to enable or disable the switch services.) The switch can be discovered by a network management system or other third-party applications. By default, Bonjour is enabled and runs on the Management VLAN. The Bonjour console automatically detects the device and displays it.

Bonjour in Layer 2 System Mode


Bonjour Discovery can only be enabled globally, and not on a per-port or perVLAN basis. The switch advertises the services enabled by the administrator. When Bonjour Discovery and IGMP are both enabled, the IP Multicast address of Bonjour appears on the Adding IP Multicast Group Addresses page. When Bonjour Discovery is disabled, the switch stops service type advertisements and does not respond to requests for service from network management applications.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

69

Administration: Discovery
LLDP and CDP

By default, Bonjour is enabled on all interfaces that are members of the Management VLAN. To globally enable Bonjour:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - Bonjour. The Discovery - Bonjour page

appears.
STEP 2 Select Enable to enable Bonjour Discovery globally on the switch. STEP 3 Click Apply. Bonjour is enabled or disabled on the switch according to the

selection.

LLDP and CDP


LLDP (Link Layer Discovery Protocol) and CDP (Cisco Discovery Protocol) are link layer protocols for directly-connected LLDP and CDP-capable neighbors to advertise themselves and their capabilities to each other. By default, the switch sends an LLDP/CDP advertisement periodically to all its interfaces and terminates and processes incoming LLDP and CDP packets as required by the protocols. In LLDP and CDP, advertisements are encoded as TLV (Type, Length, Value) in the packet. The following CDP/LLDP configuration notes apply: CDP/LLDP can be globally enabled or disabled and enabled/disabled per port. The CDP/LLDP capability of a port is relevant only if CDP/LLDP is globally enabled. If CDP/LLDP is globally enabled, the switch filters out incoming CDP/LLDP packets from ports that are CDP/LLDP-disabled. If CDP/LLDP is globally disabled, the switch can be configured to discard, VLAN-aware flooding, or VLAN-unaware flooding of all incoming CDP/LLDP packets. VLAN-aware flooding floods an incoming CDP/LLDP packet to the VLAN where the packet is received excluding the ingress port. VLANunaware flooding floods an incoming CDP/LLDP packet to all the ports excluding the ingress port. The default is to discard CDP/LLDP packets when CDP/LLDP is globally disabled. You can configure the discard/ flooding of incoming CDP and LLDP packets from the CDP Properties page and the LLDP Properties page respectively.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

70

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

Auto Smartport requires CDP and/or LLDP to be enabled. Auto Smartport automatically configures an interface based on the CDP/LLDP advertisement received from the interface. CDP and LLDP end devices, such as IP phones, learn the voice VLAN configuration from CDP and LLDP advertisements. By default, the switch is enabled to send out CDP and LLDP advertisement based on the voice VLAN configured at the switch. Refer to the Voice VLAN and Auto Voice VLAN sections for details.

NOTE CDP/LLDP does not distinguish if a port is in a LAG. If there are multiple ports in a

LAG, CDP/LLDP transmit packets on each port without taking into account the fact that the ports are in a LAG. The operation of CDP/LLDP is independent of the STP status of an interface. If 802.1x port access control is enabled at an interface, the switch transmits and receives CDP/LLDP packets to and from the interface only if the interface is authenticated and authorized. If a port is the target of mirroring, then according to CDP/LLDP it is considered down.
NOTE CDP and LLDP are link layer protocols for directly-connected CDP/LLDP capable

devices to advertise themselves and their capabilities. In deployments where the CDP/LLDP-capable devices are not directly connected and are separated with CDP/LLDP-incapable devices, the CDP/LLDP-capable devices may be able to receive the advertisement from other device(s) only if the CDP/LLDP-incapable devices flood the CDP/LLDP packets they receives. If the CDP/LLDP-incapable devices perform VLAN-aware flooding, then CDP/LLDP-capable devices can hear each other only if they are in the same VLAN. A CDP/LLDP-capable device may receive advertisement from more than one device if the CDP/LLDP-incapable devices flood the CDP/LLDP packets.

Configuring LLDP
This section describes how to configure LLDP. It covers the following topics: LLDP Overview Setting LLDP Properties Editing LLDP Port Settings LLDP MED

71

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

8
Configuring LLDP MED Port Settings Displaying LLDP Port Status Displaying LLDP Local Information Displaying LLDP Neighbors Information Accessing LLDP Statistics LLDP Overloading

LLDP Overview
LLDP is a protocol that enables network managers to troubleshoot and enhance network management in multi-vendor environments. LLDP standardizes methods for network devices to advertise themselves to other systems, and to store discovered information. LLDP enables a device to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that then store the data in a Management Information Base (MIB). The network management system models the topology of the network by querying these MIB databases. LLDP is a link layer protocol. By default, the switch terminates and processes all incoming LLDP packets as required by the protocol. The LLDP protocol has an extension called LLDP Media Endpoint Discovery (LLDP-MED), which provides and accepts information from media endpoint devices such as VoIP phones and video phones. For further information about LLDP-MED, see LLDP MED. LLDP Configuration Workflow Following are examples of actions that can be performed with the LLDP feature and in a suggested order. You can refer to the LLDP/CDP section for additional guidelines on LLDP configuration. LLDP configuration pages are accessible under the Administration > Discovery LLDP menu. 1. Enter LLDP global parameters, such as the time interval for sending LLDP updates using the LLDP Properties page. 2. Configure LLDP per port by using the Port Settings page On this page, interfaces can be configured to receive/transmit LLDP PDUs, specify which TLVs to advertise, and advertise the switch's management address. 3. Create LLDP MED network policies by using the LLDP MED Network Policy page.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

72

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

4. Associate LLDP MED network policies and the optional LLDP-MED TLVs to the desired interfaces by using the LLDP MED Port Settings page. 5. If Auto Smartport is to detect the capabilities of LLDP devices, enable LLDP in the Smartport Properties page. 6. Display overloading information by using the LLDP Overloading page.

Setting LLDP Properties


The LLDP Properties page enables entering LLDP general parameters, such as enabling/disabling the feature globally and setting timers. To enter LLDP properties:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > Properties. The Properties page

appears.
STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

LLDP StatusSelect to enable LLDP on the switch (enabled by default). LLDP Frames HandlingIf LLDP is not enabled, select the action to be taken if a packet that matches the selected criteria is received: -

FilteringDelete the packet. FloodingForward the packet to all VLAN members.

TLV Advertise IntervalEnter the rate in seconds at which LLDP advertisement updates are sent, or use the default. Topology Change System Log Notification IntervalEnter the minimum time interval between system log notifications. Hold MultiplierEnter the amount of time that LLDP packets are held before the packets are discarded, measured in multiples of the TLV Advertise Interval. For example, if the TLV Advertise Interval is 30 seconds, and the Hold Multiplier is 4, then the LLDP packets are discarded after 120 seconds. Reinitializing DelayEnter the time interval in seconds that passes between disabling and reinitializing LLDP, following an LLDP enable/disable cycle. Transmit DelayEnter the amount of time in seconds that passes between successive LLDP frame transmissions due to changes in the LLDP local systems MIB.

73

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

STEP 3 In the Fast Start Repeat Count field, enter the number of times LLDP packets are

sent when the LLDP-MED Fast Start mechanism is initialized. This occurs when a new endpoint device links to the switch. For a description of LLDP MED, refer to the LLDP MED Network Policy section.
STEP 4 Click Apply. The LLDP properties are added to the Running Configuration file.

Editing LLDP Port Settings


Use the Port Settings page to activate LLDP and remote log server notification per port, and to select the TLVs included in LLDP PDUs. The LLDP-MED TLVs to be advertised can be selected in the LLDP MED Port Settings page, and the management address TLV of the switch may be configured. To define the LLDP port settings:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > Port Settings. The Port Settings page

appears. This page contains the port LLDP information.


STEP 2 Select a port and click Edit. The Edit LLDP Port Settings page appears.

This page provides the following fields: InterfaceSelect the port to edit. Administrative StatusSelect the LLDP publishing option for the port. The values are: Tx OnlyPublishes but does not discover. Rx OnlyDiscovers but does not publish. Tx & RxPublishes and discovers. DisableIndicates that LLDP is disabled on the port.

System Log NotificationSelect Enable to notify notification recipients that there has been a topology change. The time interval between notifications is entered in the Topology Change System Log Notification Interval field in the LLDP Properties page.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

74

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

Available Optional TLVsSelect the information to be published by the switch by moving the TLV to the Selected Optional TLVs list. The available TLVs contain the following information: Port DescriptionInformation about the port, including manufacturer, product name and hardware/software version. System NameSystem's assigned name (in alpha-numeric format). The value equals the sysName object. System DescriptionDescription of the network entity (in alphanumeric format). This includes the system's name and versions of the hardware, operating system, and networking software supported by the switch. The value equals the sysDescr object. System CapabilitiesPrimary functions of the switch, and whether or not these functions are enabled in the switch. The capabilities are indicated by two octets. Bits 0 through 7 indicate Other, Repeater, Bridge, WLAN AP, Router, Telephone, DOCSIS cable device, and station respectively. Bits 8 through 15 are reserved. 802.3 MAC-PHYDuplex and bit rate capability and the current duplex and bit rate settings of the sending device. It also indicates whether the current settings are due to auto-negotiation or manual configuration. 802.3 Link AggregationWhether the link (associated with the port on which the LLDP PDU is transmitted) can be aggregated. It also indicates whether the link is currently aggregated, and if so, provides the aggregated port identifier. 802.3 Maximum FrameMaximum frame size capability of the MAC/ PHY implementation.

The following fields relate to the Management Address: Advertisement ModeSelect one of the following ways to advertise the IP management address of the switch: Auto AdvertiseSpecifies that the software would automatically choose a management address to advertise from all the IP addresses of the product. In case of multiple IP addresses the software chooses the lowest IP address among the dynamic IP addresses. If there are no dynamic addresses, the software chooses the lowest IP address among the static IP addresses. NoneDo not advertise the management IP address.

75

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

8
Manual AdvertiseSelect this option and the management IP address to be advertised. IP AddressIf Manual Advertise was selected, select the Management IP address from the addresses provided.

STEP 3 Enter the relevant information, and click Apply. The port settings are written to the

Running Configuration file.

LLDP MED
LLDP Media Endpoint Discovery (LLDP-MED) is an extension of LLDP that provides
the following additional capabilities to support media endpoint devices. Some of the features of the LLDP Med Network Policy are: Enables the advertisement and discovery of network polices for real-time applications such as voice and/or video. Device location discovery to allow creation of location databases and, in the case of Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP), Emergency Call Service (E-911) by using IP Phone location information. Troubleshooting information. LLDP MED sends alerts to network managers upon: Port speed and duplex mode conflicts QoS policy misconfigurations

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

76

8
Setting LLDP MED Network Policy

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

An LLDP-MED network policy is a related set of configuration settings for a specific real-time application such as voice, or video. A network policy, if configured, can be included in the outgoing LLDP packets to the attached LLDP media endpoint device. The media endpoint device must send its traffic as specified in the network policy it receives. For example, a policy can be created for VoIP traffic that instructs VoIP phone to: Send voice traffic on VLAN 10 as tagged packet and with 802.1p priority 5. Send voice traffic with DSCP 46.

Network policies are associated with ports by using the LLDP MED Port Settings page. An administrator can manually configure one or more network policies and the interfaces where the policies are to be sent. It is the administrator's responsibility to manually create the VLANs and their port memberships according to the network policies and their associated interfaces. In addition, an administrator can instruct the switch to automatically generate and advertise a network policy for voice application based on the voice VLAN maintained by the switch. Refer the Auto Voice VLAN section for details on how the switch maintains its voice VLAN. To define an LLDP MED network policy:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > LLDP MED Network Policy. The

LLDP MED Network Policy page appears. This page contains previously-created network policies.
STEP 2 Select Auto for LLDP-MED Network Policy for Voice Application if the switch is to

automatically generate and advertise a network policy for voice application based on the voice VLAN maintained by the switch.
NOTE When this box is checked, you may not manually configure a voice

network policy.
STEP 3 Click Apply to add this setting to the Running Configuration file. STEP 4 To define a new policy, click Add and the Add LLDP MED Network Policy page

appears.
STEP 5 Enter the values:

Network Policy NumberSelect the number of the policy to be created.

77

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

8
ApplicationSelect the type of application (type of traffic) for which the network policy is being defined. VLAN IDEnter the VLAN ID to which the traffic must be sent. VLAN TagSelect whether the traffic is Tagged or Untagged. User PrioritySelect the traffic priority applied to traffic defined by this network policy. This is the CoS value. DSCP ValueSelect the DSCP value to associate with application data sent by neighbors. This informs them how they must mark the application traffic they send to the switch.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The network policy is defined. NOTE You must manually configure the interfaces to include the desired manually-defined network policies for the outgoing LLDP packets using the LLDP MED Port Settings.

Configuring LLDP MED Port Settings


The LLDP MED Port Settings page enables the selection of the LLDP-MED TLVs and/or the network policies to be included in the outgoing LLDP advertisement for the desired interfaces. Network Policies are configured using the LLDP MED Network Policy page.
NOTE If LLDP-MED Network Policy for Voice Application (LLDP-MED Network Policy

Page) is Auto and Auto Voice VLAN is in operation, then the switch automatically generates an LLDP-MED Network Policy for Voice Application for all the ports that are LLDP-MED enabled and are members of the voice VLAN. To configure LLDP MED on each port:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > LLDP MED Port Settings. The LLDP

MED Port Settings page appears. This page contains LLDP MED settings, including enabled TLVs, for all ports.
STEP 2 The message at the top of the page indicates whether the generation of the LLDP

MED Network Policy for the voice application is automatic or not (see LLDP Overview). Click on the link to change the mode.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

78

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

STEP 3 To associate additional LLDP MED TLV and/or one or more user-defined LLDP

MED Network Policies to a port, select it, and click Edit. The Edit LLDP MED Port Settings page appears.
STEP 4 Enter the parameters:

InterfaceSelect the interface to configure. LLDP MED StatusEnable/disable LLDP MED on this port. System Log NotificationSelect whether the log notification is sent on a per-port basis, when an end station that supports MED has been discovered. Available Optional TLVsSelect the TLVs that can be published by the switch by moving them to the Selected Optional TLVs list. Available Network PoliciesSelect the LLDP MED policies to be published by LLDP by moving them to the Selected Network Policies list. These were created in the LLDP MED Network Policy page. To include one or more userdefined network polices in the advertisement, you must also select Network Policy from the Available Optional TLVs.
NOTE The following fields must be entered in hexadecimal characters in the exact data format that is defined in the LLDP-MED standard (ANSI-TIA1057_final_for_publication.pdf):

Location CoordinateEnter the coordinate location to be published by LLDP. Location Civic AddressEnter the civic address to be published by LLDP. Location (ECS) ELINEnter the Emergency Call Service (ECS) ELIN location to be published by LLDP.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The LLDP MED port settings are written to the Running Configuration

file.

79

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

Displaying LLDP Port Status


The LLDP Port Status Table page contains the LLDP global information for every port.
STEP 1 To view the LLDP port status, click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > LLDP

Port Status. The LLDP Port Status page appears.


STEP 2 Click LLDP Local Information Detail to see the details of the LLDP and LLDP-MED

TLVs sent to the neighbor.


STEP 3 Click LLDP Neighbor Information Detail to see the details of the LLDP and LLDP-

MED TLVs received from the neighbor. LLDP Port Status Global Information Chassis ID SubtypeType of chassis ID (for example, MAC address). Chassis IDIdentifier of chassis. Where the chassis ID subtype is a MAC address, the MAC address of the switch appears. System NameName of switch. System DescriptionDescription of the switch (in alpha-numeric format). Supported System CapabilitiesPrimary functions of the device, such as Bridge, WLAN AP, or Router. Enabled System CapabilitiesPrimary enabled function(s) of the device. Port ID SubtypeType of the port identifier that is shown.

LLDP Port Status Table InterfacePort identifier. LLDP StatusLLDP publishing option. LLDP MED StatusEnabled or disabled. Local PoELocal PoE information advertised. Remote PoEPoE information advertised by the neighbor. # of neighborsNumber of neighbors discovered. Neighbor Capability of 1st DeviceDisplays the primary functions of the neighbor; for example: Bridge or Router.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

80

8
Displaying LLDP Local Information

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

To view the LLDP local port status advertised on a port:


STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > LLDP Local Information. The LLDP

Local Information page appears.


STEP 2 On the bottom of the page, click LLDP Port Status Table.

Click LLDP Local Information Details to see the details of the LLDP and LLDP MED TLVs sent to the neighbor. Click LLDP Neighbor Information Details to see the details of the LLDP and LLDPMED TLVs received from the neighbor.
STEP 3 Select the desired port from the Port list.

This page provides the following fields: Global Chassis ID SubtypeType of chassis ID. (For example, the MAC address.) Chassis IDIdentifier of chassis. Where the chassis ID subtype is a MAC address, the MAC address of the switch appears. System NameName of switch. System DescriptionDescription of the switch (in alpha-numeric format). Supported System CapabilitiesPrimary functions of the device, such as Bridge, WLAN AP, or Router. Enabled System CapabilitiesPrimary enabled function(s) of the device. Port ID SubtypeType of the port identifier that is shown. Port IDIdentifier of port. Port DescriptionInformation about the port, including manufacturer, product name and hardware/software version.

Management Address Displays the table of addresses of the local LLDP agent. Other remote managers can use this address to obtain information related to the local device. The address consists of the following elements: Address SubtypeType of management IP address that is listed in the Management Address field; for example, IPv4.
Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

81

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

8
AddressReturned address most appropriate for management use,. Interface SubtypeNumbering method used for defining the interface number. Interface NumberSpecific interface associated with this management address.

MAC/PHY Details Auto-Negotiation SupportedPort speed auto-negotiation support status. Auto-Negotiation EnabledPort speed auto-negotiation active status. Auto-Negotiation Advertised CapabilitiesPort speed auto-negotiation capabilities; for example, 1000BASE-T half duplex mode, 100BASE-TX full duplex mode. Operational MAU TypeMedium Attachment Unit (MAU) type. The MAU performs physical layer functions, including digital data conversion from the Ethernet interfaces collision detection and bit injection into the network; for example, 100BASE-TX full duplex mode.

802.3 Details 802.3 Maximum Frame SizeThe maximum supported IEEE 802.3 frame size.

802.3 Link Aggregation Aggregation CapabilityIndicates whether the interface can be aggregated. Aggregation StatusIndicates whether the interface is aggregated. Aggregation Port IDAdvertised aggregated interface ID.

802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) (If device supports EEE) Local TxIndicates the time (in micro seconds) that the transmitting link partner waits before it starts transmitting data after leaving Low Power Idle (LPI mode). Local RxIndicates the time (in micro seconds) that the receiving link partner requests that the transmitting link partner waits before transmission of data following Low Power Idle (LPI mode). Remote Tx EchoIndicates the local link partners reflection of the remote link partners Tx value.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

82

8
MED Details

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

Remote Rx EchoIndicates the local link partners reflection of the remote link partners Rx value.

Capabilities SupportedMED capabilities supported on the port. Current CapabilitiesMED capabilities enabled on the port. Device ClassLLDP-MED endpoint device class. The possible device classes are: -

Endpoint Class 1Indicates a generic endpoint class, offering basic


LLDP services.

Endpoint Class 2Indicates a media endpoint class, offering media


streaming capabilities, as well as all Class 1 features.

Endpoint Class 3Indicates a communications device class, offering all Class 1 and Class 2 features plus location, 911, Layer 2 switch support, and device information management capabilities.

PoE Device TypePort PoE type; for example, powered. PoE Power SourcePort power source. PoE Power PriorityPort power priority. PoE Power ValuePort power value. Hardware RevisionHardware version. Firmware RevisionFirmware version. Software RevisionSoftware version. Serial NumberDevice serial number. Manufacturer NameDevice manufacturer name. Model NameDevice model name. Asset IDAsset ID.

Location Information CivicStreet address. CoordinatesMap coordinates: latitude, longitude, and altitude.

83

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

8
ECS ELINEmergency Call Service (ECS) Emergency Location Identification Number (ELIN).

Network Policy Table Application TypeNetwork policy application type; for example, Voice. VLAN IDVLAN ID for which the network policy is defined. VLAN TypeVLAN type for which the network policy is defined. The possible field values are:

TaggedIndicates the network policy is defined for tagged VLANs. UntaggedIndicates the network policy is defined for untagged VLANs.

User PriorityNetwork policy user priority. DSCPNetwork policy DSCP.

Displaying LLDP Neighbors Information


The LLDP Neighbors Information page contains information that was received from neighboring devices. After timeout (based on the value received from the neighbor Time To Live TLV during which no LLDP PDU was received from a neighbor), the information is deleted. To view the LLDP neighbors information:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > LLDP Neighbors Information. The

LLDP Neighbors Information page appears. This page contains the following fields: Local PortNumber of the local port to which the neighbor is connected. Chassis ID SubtypeType of chassis ID (for example, MAC address). Chassis IDIdentifier of the 802 LAN neighboring device's chassis. Port ID SubtypeType of the port identifier that is shown. Port IDIdentifier of port. System NamePublished name of the switch.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

84

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

Time to LiveTime interval (in seconds) after which the information for this neighbor is deleted.

STEP 2 Select a local port, and click Details. The Neighbors Information page appears.

This page contains the following fields: Port Details Local PortPort number. MSAP EntryDevice Media Service Access Point (MSAP) entry number.

Basic Details Chassis ID SubtypeType of chassis ID (for example, MAC address). Chassis IDIdentifier of the 802 LAN neighboring device chassis. Port ID SubtypeType of the port identifier that is shown. Port IDIdentifier of port. Port DescriptionInformation about the port, including manufacturer, product name and hardware/software version. System NameName of system that is published. System DescriptionDescription of the network entity (in alpha-numeric format). This includes the system name and versions of the hardware, operating system, and networking software supported by the device. The value equals the sysDescr object. Supported System CapabilitiesPrimary functions of the device. The capabilities are indicated by two octets. Bits 0 through 7 indicate Other, Repeater, Bridge, WLAN AP, Router, Telephone, DOCSIS cable device, and station, respectively. Bits 8 through 15 are reserved. Enabled System CapabilitiesPrimary enabled function(s) of the device.

Management Address Table Address SubtypeManaged address subtype; for example, MAC or IPv4. AddressManaged address. Interface SubtypePort subtype. Interface NumberPort number.

85

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

8
Auto-Negotiation SupportedPort speed auto-negotiation support status. The possible values are True and False. Auto-Negotiation EnabledPort speed auto-negotiation active status. The possible values are True and False. Auto-Negotiation Advertised CapabilitiesPort speed auto-negotiation capabilities, for example, 1000BASE-T half duplex mode, 100BASE-TX full duplex mode. Operational MAU TypeMedium Attachment Unit (MAU) type. The MAU performs physical layer functions, including digital data conversion from the Ethernet interfaces collision detection and bit injection into the network; for example, 100BASE-TX full duplex mode.

MAC/PHY Details

802.3 Power via MDI MDI Power Support Port ClassAdvertised power support port class. PSE MDI Power SupportIndicates if MDI power is supported on the port. PSE MDI Power StateIndicates if MDI power is enabled on the port. PSE Power Pair Control AbilityIndicates if power pair control is supported on the port. PSE Power PairPower pair control type supported on the port. PSE Power ClassAdvertised power class of the port.

802.3 Details 802.3 Maximum Frame SizeAdvertised maximum frame size that is supported on the port.

802.3 Link Aggregation Aggregation CapabilityIndicates if the port can be aggregated. Aggregation StatusIndicates if the port is currently aggregated. Aggregation Port IDAdvertised aggregated port ID.

802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) Remote TxIndicates the time (in micro seconds) that the transmitting link partner waits before it starts transmitting data after leaving Low Power Idle (LPI mode).

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

86

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

Remote RxIndicates the time (in micro seconds) that the receiving link partner requests that the transmitting link partner waits before transmission of data following Low Power Idle (LPI mode). Local Tx EchoIndicates the local link partners reflection of the remote link partners Tx value. Local Rx EchoIndicates the local link partners reflection of the remote link partners Rx value.

MED Details Capabilities SupportedMED capabilities enabled on the port. Current CapabilitiesMED TLVs advertised by the port. Device ClassLLDP-MED endpoint device class. The possible device classes are: Endpoint Class 1Indicates a generic endpoint class, offering basic LLDP services. Endpoint Class 2Indicates a media endpoint class, offering media streaming capabilities as well as all Class 1 features. Endpoint Class 3Indicates a communications device class, offering all Class 1 and Class 2 features plus location, 911, Layer 2 switch support and device information management capabilities.

PoE Device TypePort PoE type, for example, powered. PoE Power SourcePorts power source. PoE Power PriorityPorts power priority. PoE Power ValuePorts power value. Hardware Revision Hardware version. Firmware RevisionFirmware version. Software RevisionSoftware version. Serial NumberDevice serial number. Manufacturer NameDevice manufacturer name. Model NameDevice model name. Asset IDAsset ID.

87

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

8
PVIDAdvertised port VLAN ID.

802.1 VLAN and Protocol

PPVID Table VIDProtocol VLAN ID. SupportedSupported Port and Protocol VLAN IDs. EnabledEnabled Port and Protocol VLAN IDs.

VLAN IDs VIDPort and Protocol VLAN ID. VLAN NamesAdvertised VLAN names.

Protocol IDs Protocol ID TableAdvertised protocol IDs.

Location Information Enter the following data structures in hexadecimal as described in section 10.2.4 of the ANSI-TIA-1057 standard: CivicCivic or street address. CoordinatesLocation map coordinateslatitude, longitude, and altitude. ECS ELINDevices Emergency Call Service (ECS) Emergency Location Identification Number (ELIN). UnknownUnknown location information.

Network Policies Application TypeNetwork policy application type, for example, Voice. VLAN IDVLAN ID for which the network policy is defined. VLAN TypeVLAN type, Tagged or Untagged, for which the network policy is defined. User PriorityNetwork policy user priority. DSCPNetwork policy DSCP.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

88

8
Accessing LLDP Statistics

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

The LLDP Statistics page displays LLDP statistical information per port. To view the LLDP statistics:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > LLDP Statistics. The LLDP Statistics

page appears. For each port, the fields are displayed: InterfaceIdentifier of interface. Tx Frames TotalNumber of transmitted frames. Rx Frames

TotalNumber of received frames. DiscardedTotal number of received frames that were discarded. ErrorsTotal number of received frames with errors.

Rx TLVs -

DiscardedTotal number of received TLVs that were discarded. UnrecognizedTotal number of received TLVs that were unrecognized.

Neighbors Information Deletion CountNumber of neighbor ageouts on the interface.

STEP 2 Click Refresh to view the latest statistics.

LLDP Overloading
LLDP adds information as LLDP and LLDP-MED TLVs into the LLDP packets. LLDP overload occurs when the total amount of information to be included in a LLDP packet exceed the maximum PDU size supported by an interface. The LLDP Overloading page displays the number of bytes of LLDP/LLDP-MED information, the number of available bytes for additional LLDP information, and the overloading status of every interface.

89

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

To view LLDP overloading information:


STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - LLDP > LLDP Overloading. The LLDP

Overloading page appears. This page contains the following fields for each port: InterfacePort identifier. Total (Bytes)Total number of bytes of LLDP information in each packet Left to Send (Bytes)Total number of available bytes left for additional LLDP information in each packet. StatusWhether TLVs are being transmitted or if they are overloaded.

STEP 2 To view the overloading details for a port, select it and click Details. The LLDP

Overloading Details appears. This page contains the following information for each TLV sent on the port: LLDP Mandatory TLVs Size (Bytes)Total mandatory TLV byte size. StatusIf the mandatory TLV group is being transmitted, or if the TLV group was overloaded.

LLDP MED Capabilities Size (Bytes)Total LLDP MED capabilities packets byte size. StatusIf the LLDP MED capabilities packets were sent, or if they were overloaded.

LLDP MED Location -

Size (Bytes)Total LLDP MED location packets byte size. StatusIf the LLDP MED locations packets were sent, or if they were overloaded.

LLDP MED Network Policy -

Size (Bytes)Total LLDP MED network policies packets byte size. StatusIf the LLDP MED network policies packets were sent, or if they
were overloaded.

LLDP MED Extended Power via MDI

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

90

8
size.

Administration: Discovery
Configuring LLDP

Size (Bytes)Total LLDP MED extended power via MDI packets byte StatusIf the LLDP MED extended power via MDI packets were sent, or if they were overloaded.

802.3 TLVs -

Size (Bytes)Total LLDP MED 802.3 TLVs packets byte size. StatusIf the LLDP MED 802.3 TLVs packets were sent, or if they were
overloaded.

LLDP Optional TLVs -

Size (Bytes)Total LLDP MED optional TLVs packets byte size. StatusIf the LLDP MED optional TLVs packets were sent, or if they were
overloaded.

LLDP MED Inventory -

Size (Bytes)Total LLDP MED inventory TLVs packets byte size. StatusIf the LLDP MED inventory packets were sent, or if they were overloaded.

Total (Bytes)Total number of bytes of LLDP information in each packet Left to Send (Bytes)Total number of available bytes left for additional LLDP information in each packet.

91

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

Configuring CDP
This section describes how to configure CDP. It covers the following topics: Setting CDP Properties Editing CDP Interface Settings Displaying CDP Local Information Displaying CDP Neighbors Information Viewing CDP Statistics

Setting CDP Properties


Similar to LLDP, CDP (Cisco Discovery Protocol) is a link layer protocol for directly connected neighbors to advertise themselves and their capabilities to each other. Unlike LLDP, CDP is a Cisco proprietary protocol.

CDP Configuration Workflow


The followings is sample workflow in configuring CDP on the switch. You can also find additional CDP configuration guidelines in the LLDP/CDP section.
STEP 1 Enter the CDP global parameters using the CDP Properties page STEP 2 Configure CDP per interface using the Interface Setting page STEP 3 If Auto Smartport is to detect the capabilities of CDP devices, enable CDP in the

Smartport Properties page. See Identifying Smartport Type for a description of how CDP is used to identify devices for the Smartport feature. To enter CDP general parameters:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - CDP > Properties. The Properties page

appears.
STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

CDP StatusSelect to enable CDP on the switch.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

92

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

CDP Frames HandlingIf CDP is not enabled, select the action to be taken if a packet that matches the selected criteria is received:

BridgingForward the packet based on the VLAN. FilteringDelete the packet. FloodingVLAN unaware flooding that forwards incoming CDP packets
to all the ports excluding the ingress ports.

CDP Voice VLAN AdvertisementSelect to enable the switch to advertise the voice VLAN in CDP on all of the ports that are CDP enabled, and are member of the voice VLAN. The voice VLAN is configured in the Voice VLAN Properties page. CDP Mandatory TLVs ValidationIf selected, incoming CDP packets not containing the mandatory TLVs are discarded and the invalid error counter is incremented. CDP VersionSelect the version of CDP to use. CDP Hold TimeAmount of time that CDP packets are held before the packets are discarded, measured in multiples of the TLV Advertise Interval. For example, if the TLV Advertise Interval is 30 seconds, and the Hold Multiplier is 4, then the LLDP packets are discarded after 120 seconds. The following options are possible: Use DefaultUse the default time (180 seconds) User DefinedEnter the time in seconds.

CDP Transmission RateThe rate in seconds at which CDP advertisement updates are sent. The following options are possible: Use DefaultUse the default rate (60 seconds) User DefinedEnter the rate in seconds.

Device ID FormatSelect the format of the device ID (MAC address or serial number). Source InterfaceIP address to be used in the TLV of the frames. The following options are possible: Use DefaultUse the IP address of the outgoing interface. User DefinedUse the IP address of the interface (in the Interface field) in the address TLV.

93

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

8
InterfaceIF User Defined was selected for Source Interface, select the interface. Syslog Voice VLAN MismatchCheck to send a SYSLOG message when a voice VLAN mismatch is detected. This means that the voice VLAN information in the incoming frame does not match what the local device is advertising. Syslog Native VLAN MismatchCheck to send a SYSLOG message when a native VLAN mismatch is detected. This means that the native VLAN information in the incoming frame does not match what the local device is advertising. Syslog Duplex MismatchCheck to send a SYSLOG message when duplex information is mismatched. This means that the duplex information in the incoming frame does not match what the local device is advertising.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The LLDP properties are defined.

Editing CDP Interface Settings


Use the Interface Settings page to activate LLDP and remote log server notification per port, and to select the TLVs included in LLDP PDUs. By setting these properties it is possible to select the types of information to be provided to devices that support the LLDP protocol. The LLDP-MED TLVs to be advertised can be selected in the LLDP MED Interface Settings page. To define the LLDP interface settings:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - CDP > Interface Settings. The Interface

Settings page appears. This page contains the following CDP information for each interface. CDP StatusCDP publishing option for the port. Reporting Conflicts with CDP NeighborsDisplays the status of the reporting options that are enabled/disabled in the Edit page (Voice VLAN/ Native VLAN/Duplex). No. of NeighborsNumber of neighbors detected.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

94

8
The bottom of the page has four buttons: EditFields explained in Step 2 below.

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

Copy SettingsSelect to copy a configuration from one port to another.

CDP Local Information DetailsTakes you to the Administration > Discovery - CDP > CDP Local Information page. CDP Neighbor Information DetailsTakes you to the Administration > Discovery - CDP > CDP Neighbor Information page.

STEP 2 Select a port and click Edit. The Edit CDP Interface Settings page appears.

This page provides the following fields: InterfaceSelect the interface to be defined. CDP StatusSelect to enable/disable the CDP publishing option for the port.
NOTE The next three fields are operational when the switch has been set up to send traps to the management station.

Syslog Voice VLAN MismatchSelect to enable the option of sending a SYSLOG message when a voice VLAN mismatch is detected This means that the voice VLAN information in the incoming frame does not match what the local device is advertising. Syslog Native VLAN MismatchSelect to enable the option of sending a SYSLOG message when a native VLAN mismatch is detected. This means that the native VLAN information in the incoming frame does not match what the local device is advertising. Syslog Duplex MismatchSelect to enable the option of sending a SYSLOG message when duplex information mismatch is detected. This means that the duplex information in the incoming frame does not match what the local device is advertising.

STEP 3 Enter the relevant information, and click Apply. The port settings are written to the

Running Configuration.

95

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

Displaying CDP Local Information


To view information that is advertised by the CDP protocol about the local device:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - CDP > CDP Local Information. The CDP

Local Information page appears.


STEP 2 Select a local port, and the following fields are displayed:

InterfaceNumber of the local port. CDP StateDisplays whether CDP is enabled or not. Device ID TLV Device ID TypeType of the device ID advertised in the device ID TLV. Device IDDevice ID advertised in the device ID TLV.

System Name TLV System NameSystem name of the device.

Address TLV Address1-3IP addresses (advertised in the device address TLV).

Port TLV Port IDIdentifier of port advertised in the port TLV.

Capabilities TLV CapabilitiesCapabilities advertised in the port TLV)

Version TLV VersionInformation about the software release on which the device is running.

Platform TLV PlatformIdentifier of platform advertised in the platform TLV.

Native VLAN TLV Native VLANThe native VLAN identifier advertised in the native VLAN TLV.

Full/Half Duplex TLV

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

96

8
Appliance TLV

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

DuplexWhether port is half or full duplex advertised in the full/half duplex TLV.

Appliance IDType of device attached to port advertised in the appliance TLV. Appliance VLAN IDVLAN on the device used by the appliance, for instance if the appliance is an IP phone, this is the voice VLAN.

Extended Trust TLV Extended TrustEnabled indicates that the port is trusted, meaning that the host/server from which the packet is received is trusted to mark the packets itself. In this case, packets received on such a port are not remarked. Disabled indicates that the port is not trusted in which case, the following field is relevant.

CoS for Untrusted Ports TLV CoS for Untrusted PortsIf Extended Trust is disabled on the port, this fields displays the Layer 2 CoS value, meaning, an 802.1D/802.1p priority value. This is the COS value with which all packets received on an untrusted port are remarked by the device.

Power TLV Request IDLast power request ID received echoes the Request-ID field last received in a Power Requested TLV. It is 0 if no Power Requested TLV was received since the interface last transitioned to Up. Power Management IDValue incremented by 1 (or 2, to avoid 0) each time any one of the following events occur: Available-Power or Management Power Level fields change value A Power Requested TLV is received with a Request-ID field which is different from the last-received set (or when the first value is received) The interface transitions to Down Available PowerAmount of power consumed by port. Management Power LevelDisplays the supplier's request to the powered device for its Power Consumption TLV. The device always displays No Preference in this field.

97

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

Displaying CDP Neighbors Information


The CDP Neighbors Information page displays CDP information received from neighboring devices. After timeout (based on the value received from the neighbor Time To Live TLV during which no CDP PDU was received from a neighbor), the information is deleted. To view the CDP neighbors information:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - CDP > CDP Neighbor Information. The CDP

Neighbor Information page appears. This page contains the following fields for the link partner (neighbor): Device IDNeighbors device ID. System nameNeighbors system name. Local InterfaceNumber of the local port to which the neighbor is connected. Advertisement VersionCDP protocol version. Time to Live (sec)Time interval (in seconds) after which the information for this neighbor is deleted. CapabilitiesCapabilities advertised by neighbor. PlatformInformation from Platform TLV of neighbor. Neighbor InterfaceOutgoing interface of the neighbor.

STEP 2 Select a device, and click Details. The CDP Neighbors Details page appears.

This page contains the following fields about the neighbor: Device IDIdentifier of the neighboring device ID. Local InterfaceInterface number of port through which frame arrived. Advertisement VersionVersion of CDP. Time to LiveTime interval (in seconds) after which the information for this neighbor is deleted.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

98

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

CapabilitiesPrimary functions of the device. The capabilities are indicated by two octets. Bits 0 through 7 indicate Other, Repeater, Bridge, WLAN AP, Router, Telephone, DOCSIS cable device, and station respectively. Bits 8 through 15 are reserved. PlatformIdentifier of the neighbors platform. Neighbor InterfaceInterface number of the neighbor through which frame arrived. Native VLANNeighbors native VLAN. DuplexWhether neighbors interface is half or full duplex. AddressesNeighbors addresses. Power DrawnAmount of power consumed by neighbor on the interface. VersionNeighbors software version.

NOTE Clicking on the Clear Table button disconnect all connected devices if from CDP,

and if Auto Smartport is enabled change all port types to default.

Viewing CDP Statistics


The CDP Statistics page displays information regarding Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP) frames that were sent or received from a port. CDP packets are received from devices attached to the switches interfaces, and are used for the Smartport feature. See Configuring CDP for more information. CDP statistics for a port are only displayed if CDP is enabled globally and on the port. This is done in the CDP Properties page and the CDP Interface Settings page. To view CDP statistics:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Discovery - CDP > CDP Statistics. The CDP Statistics page

appears. The following fields are displayed for every interface:. Packets Received/Transmitted: Version 1Number of CDP version 1 packets received/transmitted. Version 2Number of CDP version 2 packets received/transmitted.

99

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Administration: Discovery
Configuring CDP

8
TotalTotal number of CDP packets received/transmitted. Illegal ChecksumNumber of packets received with illegal checksum value. Other ErrorsNumber of packets received with errors other than illegal checksums. Neighbors Over MaximumNumber of times that packet information could not be stored in cache because of lack of room.

The CDP Error Statistics section displays the CDP error counters.

To clear all counters on all interfaces, click Clear All Interface Counters. To clear all counters on an interface, select it and click Clear All Interface Counters.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

100

9
Port Management
This section describes port configuration, link aggregation, and the Green Ethernet feature. It covers the following topics: Configuring Ports Setting Basic Port Configuration Configuring Link Aggregation Configuring Green Ethernet

Configuring Ports
To configure ports, perform the following actions: 1. Configure port by using the Port Settings page. 2. Enable/disable the Link Aggregation Control (LAG) protocol, and configure the potential member ports to the desired LAGs by using the LAG Management page. By default, all LAGs are empty. 3. Configure the Ethernet parameters, such as speed and auto-negotiation for the LAGs by using the LAG Settings page. 4. Configure the LACP parameters for the ports that are members or candidates of a dynamic LAG by using the LACP page. 5. Configure Green Ethernet and 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet by using the Properties page. 6. Configure Green Ethernet energy mode and 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet per port by using the Port Settings page. 7. If PoE is supported and enabled for the switch, configure the switch as described in Port Management: PoE.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

101

Port Management
Setting Basic Port Configuration

Setting Basic Port Configuration


The Port Settings page displays the global and per port setting of all the ports. This page enables you to select and configure the desired ports from the Edit Port Settings page. This page displays the operational status for each port. A port can be either Up or Down. It can be Down because the user requested this, or because of an error condition. If the port is Down because of an error condition, the error appears in the Operational Status field. The following reasons might be displayed: Down (Port Lock) Down (802.1X)

To configure port settings:


STEP 1 Click Port Management > Port Settings. The Port Settings page appears. STEP 2 Select Jumbo Frames to support packets of up to 10 Kb in size. If Jumbo Frames

is not enabled (default), the system supports packet size up to 2,000 bytes. For jumbo frames to take effect, the switch must be rebooted after the feature is enabled.
STEP 3 Click Apply to update the global setting.

Jumbo frames configuration changes take effect only after the Running Configuration is explicitly saved to the Startup Configuration File using the Copy/ Save Configuration page, and the switch is rebooted.
STEP 4 To update the port settings, select the desired port, and click Edit. The Edit Port

Settings page appears.


STEP 5 Modify the following parameters:

InterfaceSelect the port number. Port TypeDisplays the port type and speed. The possible options are: Copper PortsRegular, not Combo, support the following values: 10M, 100M, and 1000M (type: Copper). Combo Ports CopperCombo port connected with copper CAT5 cable, supports the following values: 10M, 100M, and 1000M (type: ComboC).

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

102

9
-

Port Management
Setting Basic Port Configuration

Combo FiberSFP Fiber Gigabit Interface Converter Port with the following values: 100M and 1000M (type: ComboF). 10G-Fiber OpticsPorts with speed of either 1G or 10G.

NOTE SFP Fiber takes precedence in Combo ports when both ports are

being used. Port DescriptionEnter the port user-defined name or comment. Administrative StatusSelect whether the port must be Up or Down when the switch is rebooted. Operational StatusDisplays whether the port is currently Up or Down. If the port is down because of an error, the description of the error appears. Reactivate Suspended PortSelect to reactivate a port that has been suspended. There are numerous ways that a port can be suspended, such as through the locked port security option, dot1x single host violation, loopback detection, or STP loopback guard. The reactivate operation brings the port up without regard to why the port was suspended. Reactivate Suspended PortSelect to reactivate a port that has been suspended. There are numerous ways that a port can be suspended, such as through the locked port security option, dot1x single host violation, loopback detection, or STP loopback guard. The reactivate operation brings the port up without regard to why the port was suspended. Auto-NegotiationSelect to enable auto-negotiation on the port. Autonegotiation enables a port to advertise its transmission speed, duplex mode, and Flow Control abilities to the port link partner. Operational Auto-NegotiationDisplays the current auto-negotiation status on the port. Administrative Port SpeedConfigure the speed of the port. The port type determines which the available speeds. You can designate Administrative Speed only when port auto-negotiation is disabled. Operational Port SpeedDisplays the current port speed that is the result of negotiation. Administrative Duplex ModeSelect the port duplex mode. This field is configurable only when auto-negotiation is disabled, and the port speed is set to 10M or 100M. At port speed of 1G, the mode is always full duplex. The possible options are:

103

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Setting Basic Port Configuration

9
FullThe interface supports transmission between the switch and the client in both directions simultaneously. HalfThe interface supports transmission between the switch and the client in only one direction at a time.

Operational Duplex ModeDisplays the ports current duplex mode. Auto AdvertisementSelect the capabilities advertised by autonegotiation when it is enabled. The options are: Max CapabilityAll port speeds and duplex mode settings can be accepted. 10 Half10 Mbps speed and Half Duplex mode. 10 Full10 Mbps speed and Full Duplex mode. 100 Half100 Mbps speed and Half Duplex mode. 100 Full100 Mbps speed and Full Duplex mode. 1000 Full1000 Mbps speed and Full Duplex mode.

Operational AdvertisementDisplays the capabilities currently published to the ports neighbor. The possible options are those specified in the Administrative Advertisement field. Neighbor AdvertisementDisplays the capabilities advertised by the neighboring device (link partner). Back PressureSelect the Back Pressure mode on the port (used with Half Duplex mode) to slow down the packet reception speed when the switch is congested. It disables the remote port, preventing it from sending packets by jamming the signal. Flow ControlEnable or disable 802.3x Flow Control, or enable the autonegotiation of Flow Control on the port (only when in Full Duplex mode). MDI/MDIXthe Media Dependent Interface (MDI)/Media Dependent Interface with Crossover (MDIX) status on the port. The options are: MDIXSelect to swap the port's transmit and receives pairs. MDISelect to connect this switch to a station by using a straight through cable.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

104

Port Management
Configuring Link Aggregation

AutoSelect to configure this switch to automatically detect the correct pinouts for the connection to another device.

Operational MDI/MDIXDisplays the current MDI/MDIX setting.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The Port Settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

Configuring Link Aggregation


This section describes how to configure LAGs. It covers the following topics: Link Aggregation Overview Static and Dynamic LAG Workflow Defining LAG Management Configuring LAG Settings Configuring LACP

Link Aggregation Overview


Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) is part of the IEEE specification (802.3az) that enables you to bundle several physical ports together to form a single logical channel (LAG). LAGs multiply the bandwidth, increase port flexibility, and provide link redundancy between two devices. Two types of LAGs are supported: StaticA LAG is static if the LACP is disabled on it. The group of ports assigned to a static LAG are always active members. After a LAG is manually created, the LACP option cannot be added or removed, until the LAG is edited and a member is removed (which can be added prior to applying), then the LACP button become available for editing. DynamicA LAG is dynamic if LACP is enabled on it. The group of ports assigned to dynamic LAG are candidate ports. LACP determines which candidate ports are active member ports. The non-active candidate ports are standby ports ready to replace any failing active member ports.

105

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Configuring Link Aggregation

Load Balancing
Traffic forwarded to a LAG is load-balanced across the active member ports, thus achieving an effective bandwidth close to the aggregate bandwidth of all the active member ports of the LAG. Traffic load balancing over the active member ports of a LAG is managed by a hash-based distribution function that distributes Unicast and Multicast traffic based on Layer 2 or Layer 3 packet header information. The switch supports two modes of load balancing: By MAC AddressesBased on the destination and source MAC addresses of all packets. By IP and MAC AddressesBased on the destination and source IP addresses for IP packets, and destination and source MAC addresses for non-IP packets.

LAG Management In general, a LAG is treated by the system as a single logical port. In particular, the LAG has port attributes similar to a regular port, such as state and speed. The switch supports four LAGs. Every LAG has the following characteristics: All ports in a LAG must be of the same media type. To add a port to the LAG, it cannot belong to any VLAN except the default VLAN. Ports in a LAG must not be assigned to another LAG. No more than eight ports are assigned to a static LAG and no more than 16 ports can be candidates for a dynamic LAG. All the ports in a LAG must have auto-negotiation disabled, although the LAG can have auto-negotiation enabled. When a port is added to a LAG, the configuration of the LAG is applied to the port. When the port is removed from the LAG, its original configuration is reapplied. Protocols, such as Spanning Tree, consider all the ports in the LAG to be one port.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

106

9
Static and Dynamic LAG Workflow

Port Management
Configuring Link Aggregation

After a LAG has been manually created, LACP cannot be added or removed until the LAG is edited and a member is removed. Only then the LACP button become available for editing. To configure a static LAG, perform the following actions: 1. Disable LACP on the LAG to make it static. Assign up to eight member ports to the static LAG by selecting and moving the ports from the Port List to the LAG Members list. Select the load balancing algorithm for the LAG. Perform these actions in the LAG Management page. 2. Configure various aspects of the LAG, such as speed and flow control by using the LAG Settings page. To configure a dynamic LAG, perform the following actions: 1. Enable LACP on the LAG. Assign up to 16 candidates ports to the dynamic LAG by selecting and moving the ports from the Port List to the LAG Members List by using the LAG Management page. 2. Configure various aspects of the LAG, such as speed and flow control by using the LAG Settings page. 3. Set the LACP priority and timeout of the ports in the LAG by using the LACP page.

Defining LAG Management


The LAG Management page displays the global and per LAG settings. The page also enables you to configure the global setting and to select and edit the desired LAG on the Edit LAG Membership page. To select the load balancing algorithm of the LAG:
STEP 1 Click Port Management > Link Aggregation > LAG Management. The LAG

Management page appears.


STEP 2 Select one of the following Load Balance Algorithms:

MAC AddressPerform load balancing by source and destination MAC addresses on all packets. IP/MAC AddressPerform load balancing by the source and destination IP addresses on IP packets, and by the source and destination MAC addresses on non-IP packets

107

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Configuring Link Aggregation

STEP 3 Click Apply. The Load Balance Algorithm is written to the Running Configuration

file.

To define the member or candidate ports in a LAG.


STEP 1 Select the LAG to be configured, and click Edit. The Edit LAG Membership page

appears.
STEP 2 Enter the values for the following fields:

LAGSelect the LAG number. LAG NameEnter the LAG name or a comment. LACPSelect to enable LACP on the selected LAG. This makes it a dynamic LAG. This field can only be enabled after moving a port to the LAG in the next field. Port ListMove those ports that are to be assigned to the LAG from the Port List to the LAG Members list. Up to eight ports per static LAG can be assigned, and 16 ports can be assigned to a dynamic LAG.

STEP 3 Click Apply. LAG membership is written to the Running Configuration file.

Configuring LAG Settings


The LAG Settings page contains a table of current settings for all LAGs. You can configure the settings of selected LAGs, and reactivate suspended LAGs by going to the Edit LAG Settings page. To configure the LAG settings or reactivate a suspended LAG:
STEP 1 Click Port Management > Link Aggregation > LAG Settings. The LAG Settings

page appears.
STEP 2 Select a LAG, and click Edit . The Edit LAG Settings page appears. STEP 3 Enter the values for the following fields:

LAGSelect the LAG ID number. DescriptionEnter the LAG name or a comment. LAG TypeDisplays the port type that comprises the LAG.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

108

Port Management
Configuring Link Aggregation

Administrative StatusSet the selected LAG to be Up or Down. Operational StatusDisplays whether the LAG is currently operating. Reactivate Suspended LAGSelect to reactivate a port if the LAG has been disabled through the locked port security option . Administrative Auto NegotiationEnables or disable auto-negotiation on the LAG. Auto-negotiation is a protocol between two link partners that enables a LAG to advertise its transmission speed and flow control to its partner (the Flow Control default is disabled). It is recommended to keep auto-negotiation enabled on both sides of an aggregate link, or disabled on both sides, while ensuring that link speeds are identical. Operational Auto NegotiationDisplays the auto-negotiation setting. Administrative SpeedSelect the LAG speed. Operational LAG SpeedDisplays the current speed at which the LAG is operating. Administrative AdvertisementSelect the capabilities to be advertised by the LAG. The options are: Max CapabilityAll LAG speeds and both duplex modes are available. 10 FullThe LAG advertises a 10 Mbps speed and the mode is full duplex. 100 FullThe LAG advertises a 100 Mbps speed and the mode is full duplex. 1000 FullThe LAG advertises a 1000 Mbps speed and the mode is full duplex.

Operational AdvertisementDisplays the Administrative Advertisement status. The LAG advertises its capabilities to its neighbor LAG to start the negotiation process. The possible values are those specified in the Administrative Advertisement field. Administrative Flow ControlSet Flow Control to either Enable or Disable or enable the Auto-Negotiation of Flow Control on the LAG. Operational Flow ControlDisplays the current Flow Control setting.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

109

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Configuring Link Aggregation

Configuring LACP
A dynamic LAG is LACP-enabled, and LACP is run on every candidate port defined in the LAG.

LACP Priority and Rules


LACP system priority and LACP port priority are both used to determine which of the candidate ports become active member ports in a dynamic LAG configured with more than eight candidate ports. The selected candidate ports of the LAG are all connected to the same remote device. Both the local and remote switches have a LACP system priority. The following algorithm is used to determine whether LACP port priorities are taken from the local or remote device: the local LACP System Priority is compared to the remote LACP System Priority. The device with the lowest priority controls candidate port selection to the LAG. If both priorities are the same, the local and remote MAC addresses are compared. The priority of the device with the lowest MAC address controls candidate port selection to the LAG. A dynamic LAG can have up to 16 Ethernet ports of the same type. Up to eight ports can be active, and up to eight ports can be in standby mode. When there are more than eight ports in the dynamic LAG, the switch on the controlling end of the link uses port priorities to determine which ports are bundled into the LAG and which ports are put in hot-standby mode. Port priorities on the other switch (the non-controlling end of the link) are ignored. The following are additional rules used to select the active or standby ports in a dynamic LACP: Any link operating at a different speed from the highest-speed active member or operating at half-duplex is made standby. All the active ports in a dynamic LAG operate at the same baud rate. If the port LACP priority of the link is lower than that of the currently-active link members, and the number of active members is already at the maximum number, the link is made inactive, and placed in standby mode.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

110

9
Setting Port LACP Parameter Settings

Port Management
Configuring Link Aggregation

The LACP page displays and enables configuration of the LACP System Priority, LACP timeout, and LACP port priority. LACP timeout is a per port parameter, and is the time interval between the sending and receiving of consecutive LACP PDUs. With all factors equal, when the LAG is configured with more candidate ports than the maximum number of active ports allowed, the switch selects ports as active from the dynamic LAG that has the highest priority
NOTE The LACP setting is irrelevant on ports that are not members of a dynamic LAG.

To define the LACP settings:


STEP 1 Click Port Management > Link Aggregation > LACP. The LACP page appears. STEP 2 Enter the LACP System Priority. See Configuring LACP. STEP 3 Select a port, and click Edit. The Edit LACP page appears. STEP 4 Enter the values for the following fields:

InterfaceSelect the port number to which timeout and priority values are assigned. LACP Port PriorityEnter the LACP priority value for the port. See Setting Port LACP Parameter Settings. LACP TimeoutSelect the periodic transmissions of LACP PDUs, which occur at either a long or short transmission speed, depending upon the expressed LACP timeout preference.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

111

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

9
This section describes the Green Ethernet feature that is designed to save power on the switch. It contains the following sections: Green Ethernet Overview Setting Global Green Ethernet Properties Setting Green Ethernet Properties for Ports

Configuring Green Ethernet

Green Ethernet Overview


Green Ethernet is a common name for a set of features that is designed to be environmentally friendly, and to reduce the power consumption of a device. Green Ethernet is different from EEE in that green ethernet energy-detect is enabled on all devices where only the Gigabyte ports are enable with EEE. The Green Ethernet feature can reduce overall power usage in the following ways: Energy-Detect ModeOn an inactive link, the port moves into inactive mode, saving power while keeping the Administrative status of the port Up. Recovery from this mode to full operational mode is fast, transparent, and no frames are lost. This mode is supported on both GE and FE ports. Short-Reach ModeThis feature provides for power savings on a short length of cable. After cable length is analyzed, the power usage is adjusted for various cable lengths. If the cable is shorter than 50 meters, the switch uses less power to send frames over the cable, thus saving energy. This mode is only supported on RJ45 GE ports; it does not apply to Combo ports. This mode is globally disabled by default. It cannot be enabled if EEE mode is enabled (see below). In addition to the above Green Ethernet features, the 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) is found on devices supporting GE ports. EEE reduces power consumption when there is no traffic on the port. See 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet Feature for more information (available on GE models only). EEE is enabled globally by default. On a given port, if EEE is enabled, short reach mode be disabled. If Short Reach Mode is enabled, EEE be grayed out.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

112

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

These modes are configured per port, without taking into account the LAG membership of the ports. Power savings, current power consumption and cumulative energy saved can be monitored. The total amount of saved energy can be viewed as a percentage of the power that would have been consumed by the physical interfaces had they not been running in Green Ethernet mode. The saved energy displayed is only related to Green Ethernet. The amount of energy saved by EEE is not displayed.

Power Saving by Disabling Port LEDs


The Disable Port LEDs feature allows the user to save extra power consumed by device LEDs. Since most of the time the devices are in an unoccupied room, having these LEDs lit is a waste of energy. The Green Ethernet feature enables you to disable the port LEDs (for link, speed, and PoE) when they are not required, and to enable the LEDs if they are needed (debugging, connecting additional devices etc.). On the System Summary page, the LEDs that are displayed on the device board pictures are not affected by disabling the LEDs. On the Green Ethernet -> Properties page, the device enables the user to disable the ports LEDs in order to save power.

802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet Feature


This section describes the 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) feature. It covers the following topics: 802.3az EEE Overview Advertise Capabilities Negotiation Link Level Discovery for 802.3az EEE Availability of 802.3az EEE Default Configuration Interactions Between Features 802.3az EEE Configuration Workflow

113

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

9
802.3az EEE Overview
802.3az EEE is designed to save power when there is no traffic on the link. In Green Ethernet, power is reduced when the port is down. With 802.3az EEE, power is reduced when the port is up, but there is no traffic on it. 802.3az EEE is only supported on devices with GE ports. When using 802.3az EEE, systems on both sides of the link can disable portions of their functionality and save power during periods of no traffic. 802.3az EEE supports IEEE 802.3 MAC operation at 100 Mbps and 1000 Mbps: LLDP is used to select the optimal set of parameters for both devices. If LLDP is not supported by the link partner, or is disabled, 802.3az EEE still be operational, but it might not be in the optimal operational mode. The 802.3az EEE feature is implemented using a port mode called Low Power Idle (LPI) mode. When there is no traffic and this feature is enabled on the port, the port is placed in the LPI mode, which reduces power consumption dramatically. Both sides of a connection (switch port and connecting device) must support 802.3az EEE for it to work. When traffic is absent, both sides send signals indicating that power is about to be reduced. When signals from both sides are received, the Keep Alive signal indicates that the ports are in LPI status (and not in Down status), and power is reduced. For ports to stay in LPI mode, the Keep Alive signal must be received continuously from both sides.

Advertise Capabilities Negotiation


802.3az EEE support is advertised during the Auto-Negotiation stage. AutoNegotiation provides a linked device with the capability to detect the abilities (modes of operation) supported by the device at the other end of the link, determine common abilities, and configure itself for joint operation. AutoNegotiation is performed at the time of link-up, on command from management, or upon detection of a link error. During the link establishment process, both link partners to exchange their 802.3az EEE capabilities. Auto-Negotiation functions automatically without user interaction when it is enabled on the device.
NOTE If Auto-Negotiation is not enabled on a port, the EEE is disabled. The

only exception is if the link speed is 1GB, then EEE still e enabled even though Auto-Negotiation is disabled.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

114

9
Link Level Discovery for 802.3az EEE

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

In addition to the capabilities described above, 802.3az EEE capabilities and settings are also advertised using frames based on the organizationally-specific TLVs defined in Annex G of IEEE Std 802.1AB protocol (LLDP). LLDP is used to further optimize 802.3az EEE operation after auto-negotiation is completed. The 802.3az EEE TLV is used to fine tune system wake-up and refresh durations.

Availability of 802.3az EEE


Please check the release notes for a complete listing of products that support EEE.

Default Configuration
By default, 802.3az EEE and EEE LLDP are enabled globally and per port.

Interactions Between Features


The following describe 802.3az EEE interactions with other features: If auto-negotiation is not enabled on the port, the 802.3az EEE operational status is disabled. The exception to this rule is that if the link speed is 1gigabyte, EEE still be enabled even though Auto-Negotiation is disabled. If 802.3az EEE is enabled and the port is going Up, it commences to work immediately in accordance with the maximum wake time value of the port. On the GUI, the EEE field for the port is not available when the Short Reach Mode option on the port is checked. If the port speed on the GE port is changed to 10Mbit, 802.3az EEE is disabled. This is supported in GE models only.

802.3az EEE Configuration Workflow


This section describes how to configure the 802.3az EEE feature and view its counters.
STEP 1 Ensure that auto-negotiation is enabled on the port by opening the Port

Management > Port Settings page. a. Select a port and open the Edit Port Setting page. b. Select Auto Negotiation field to ensure that it is Enabled.

115

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

9
Management > Green Ethernet > Properties page (it is enabled by default). This page also displays how much energy has been saved.

STEP 2 Ensure that 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) is globally enabled in the Port

STEP 3 Ensure that 802.3az EEE is enabled on a port by opening the Green Ethernet > Port

Settings page. a. Select a port, open the Edit Port Setting page. b. Check the 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) mode on the port (it is enabled by default). c. Select whether to enable or disable advertisement of 802.3az EEE capabilities through LLDP in 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) LLDP (it is enabled by default).
STEP 4 To see 802.3 EEE-related information on the local device, open the

Administration > Discovery LLDP >LLDP Local Information page, and view the information in the 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) block.
STEP 5 To display 802.3az EEE information on the remote device, open the Administration

> Discovery LLDP > LLDP Neighbor Information pages, and view the information in the 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) block.

Setting Global Green Ethernet Properties


The Properties page displays and enables configuration of the Green Ethernet mode for the switch. It also contains the current power savings. To enable Green Ethernet and EEE and view power savings:
STEP 1 Click Port Management > Green Ethernet > Properties. The Properties page

appears. Enter the values for the following fields: Energy Detect ModeDisabled by default. Click the checkbox to enable. Short ReachGlobally enable or disable Short Reach mode if there are GE ports on the switch.
NOTE If Short Reach is enabled, EEE must be disabled.

Port LEDsSelect to enable the port LEDs. When these are disabled, they do not display link status, activity, etc.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

116

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

Power SavingsDisplays the percentage of Cumulative Energy Saved from the total amount of power used. Cumulative Energy SavedDisplays the amount of power saved by the power-savings features enabled on this page (Energy Detect mode and Short Reach). The 802.3 EEE power savings is dynamic by nature since it is based on port utilization, and is therefore not taken into consideration in this field. 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) Globally enable or disable EEE mode.

STEP 2 Click Apply. The Green Ethernet Properties are written to the Running

Configuration file.

Setting Green Ethernet Properties for Ports


The Port Settings page displays the current Green Ethernet and EEE modes per port, and enables configuring Green Ethernet on a port using the Edit Port Setting page. For the Green Ethernet modes to operate on a port, the corresponding modes must be activated globally in the Properties page. Note that EEE settings are only displayed for devices that have GE ports. EEE works only when ports are set to Auto negotiation. The exception is that EEE is still functional even when Auto Negotiation is disabled, but the port is at 1GB or higher. To define per port Green Ethernet settings:
STEP 1 Click Port Management > Green Ethernet> Port Settings. The Port Settings

page appears. The Port Settings page contains the following: Global Parameter StatusDescribes the enabled features.

For each port the following fields are described: PortThe port number. Energy DetectState of the port regarding Energy Detect mode: AdministrativeDisplays whether Energy Detect mode was enabled. OperationalDisplays whether Energy Detect mode is currently operating.

117

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

9
ReasonIf Energy Detect mode is not operational, displays the reason. Short ReachState of the port regarding Short Reach mode: AdministrativeDisplays whether Short Reach mode was enabled. OperationalDisplays whether Short Reach mode is currently operating. ReasonIf Short-Reach mode is not operational, displays the reason. Cable LengthDisplays VCT-returned cable length in meters.

NOTE Short-reach mode is only supported on RJ45 GE ports; it does not

apply to Combo ports. 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE)State of the port regarding the EEE feature: AdministrativeDisplays whether EEE was enabled. OperationalDisplays whether EEE is currently operating on the local port. This is a function of whether it has been enabled (Administrative Status), whether it has been enabled on the local port and whether it is operational on the local port. LLDP AdministrativeDisplays whether advertising EEE counters through LLDP was enabled. LLDP OperationalDisplays whether advertising EEE counters through LLDP is currently operating. EEE Support on RemoteDisplays whether EEE is supported on the link partner. EEE must be supported on both the local and remote link partners.

NOTE The window displays the Short Reach, Energy Detect and EEE

settings for each port; however, they are not enabled on any port unless they are also enabled globally by using the Properties page. To enable Short Reach and EEE globally, see Setting Global Green Ethernet Properties.
STEP 2 Select a Port and click Edit. The Edit Port Setting page appears. STEP 3 Select to enable or disable Energy Detect mode on the port. STEP 4 Select to enable or disable Short Reach mode on the port if there are GE ports on

the device.
STEP 5 Select to enable or disable 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) mode on the port

if there are GE ports on the device.


Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide 118

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

STEP 6 Select to enable or disable 802.3 Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) LLDP mode on

the port (advertisement of EEE capabilities through LLDP) if there are GE ports on the device.
STEP 7 Click Apply. The Green Ethernet port settings are written to the Running

Configuration file.

119

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management
Configuring Green Ethernet

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

120

10
Smartport
This document describes the Smartports feature. It contains the following topics: Overview What is a Smartport Smartport Types Smartport Macros Macro Failure and the Reset Operation How the Smartport Feature Works Auto Smartport Error Handling Default Configuration Relationships with Other Features and Backwards Compatibility Common Smartport Tasks Configuring Smartport Using The Web-based Interface Built-in Smartport Macros

Overview
The Smartport feature provides a convenient way to save and share common configurations. By applying the same Smartport macro to multiple interfaces, the interfaces share a common set of configurations. A Smartport macro can be applied to an interface by the Smartport type associated with the macro.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

121

Smartport
What is a Smartport

10
There are two ways to apply a Smartport macro by Smartport type to an interface: Static SmartportYou manually assign a Smartport type to an interface. The result is the corresponding Smartport macro is applied to the interface. Auto SmartportAuto Smartport waits for a device to be attached to the interface before applying a configuration. When a device is detected from an interface, the Smartport macro (if assigned) that corresponds to the Smartport type of the attaching device is automatically applied.

The Smartport feature consists of various components and works in conjunction with other features on the switch. These components and features are described in the following sections: Smartport, Smartport types and Smartport macros, described in this section. Voice VLAN and Smartport, described in the Voice VLAN section. LLDP/CDP for Smartport, described in the Configuring LLDP and Configuring CDP sections, respectively.

Additionally, typical work flows are described in the Common Smartport Tasks section.

What is a Smartport
A Smartport is an interface to which a built-in macro may be applied. These macros are designed to provide a means of quickly configuring the switch to support the communication requirements and utilize the features of various types of network devices. The network access and QoS requirements vary if the interface is connected to an IP phone, a printer, or a router and/or Access Point (AP).

Smartport Types
Smartport types refers to the types of devices attached, or to be attached to Smartports. The switch supports the following Smartport types: Printer

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

122

10
Desktop Guest Server Host IP Camera IP phone IP Phone+Desktop Switch Router Wireless Access Point

Smartport
Smartport Types

Smartport types are named so that they describe the type of device connected to an interface. Each Smartport type is associated with two Smartport macros. One macro, called "the macro," serves to apply the desired configuration. The other, called "the anti-macro," serves to undo all configuration performed by "the macro" when that interface happens to become a different Smartport type. The following describes the relationship of Smartport types and Auto Smartport Smartport and Auto Smartport Types Smartport Type Unknown Default Printer Desktop Guest Server Host IP camera IP phone IP phone desktop Supported by Auto Smartport No No No No No No Yes No Yes Yes Supported by Auto Smartport by default No No No No No No No No Yes Yes

123

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Smartport Types

10
Smartport and Auto Smartport Types Smartport Type Switch Router Wireless Access Point Supported by Auto Smartport Yes Yes Yes Supported by Auto Smartport by default Yes No Yes

Special Smartport Types


There are two special Smartport types; default and unknown. These two types are not associated with macros, but they exist to signify the state of the interface regarding Smartport. The following describe these special Smartport types: Default An interface that does not (yet) have a Smartport type assigned to it has the Default Smartport status. If Auto Smartport assigns a Smartport type to an interface and the interface is not configured to be Auto Smartport Persistent, then its Smartport type is re-initialized to Default in the following cases: A link down/up operation is performed on the interface. The switch is restarted. All devices attached to the interface have aged out, which is defined as the absence of CDP and/or LLDP advertisement from the device for a specified time period.

Unknown If a Smartport macro is applied to an interface and an error occurs, the interface is assigned the Unknown status. In this case, the Smartport and Auto Smartport features do not function on the interface until you correct the error and applies the Reset action (performed in the Interface Settings pages) that resets the Smartport status. See the workflow area in Common Smartport Tasks section for troubleshooting tips.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

124

10

Smartport
Smartport Macros

NOTE Throughout this section, the term aged out is used to describe the LLDP and CDP

messages via their TTL. If Auto Smartport is enabled, and persistent status is disabled, and no more CDP or LLDP messages are received on the interface before both TTLs of the most recent CDP and LLDP packets decrease to 0, then the antimacro is run, and the Smartport type returns to default.

Smartport Macros
A Smartport macro is a script that configure an interface appropriately for a particular network device. Smartport macros should not be confused with global macros. Global macros configure the switch globally, however, the scope of a Smartport macro is limited to the interface on which it is applied. The macro source may be found by clicking the View Macro Source button on the Smartport Type Settings page. A macro and the corresponding anti-macro are paired together in association with each Smartport type. The macro applies the configuration and the anti-macro removes it. Two Smartport macros are paired by their names as follows: macro_name (for example: printer) no_macro_name (for example: no_printer, the anti Smartport macro of Smartport macro printer)

See Built-in Smartport Macros for a listing of the built-in Smartport macros for each device type.

Applying a Smartport Type to an Interface


When Smartport types are applied to interfaces, the Smartport types and configuration in the associated Smartport macros are saved in the Running Configuration File. If the administrator saves the Running Configuration File into the Startup Configuration File, the switch applies the Smartport types and the Smartport macros to the interfaces after reboot as follows: If the Startup Configuration File does not specify a Smartport type for an interface, its Smartport type is set to Default.

125

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Macro Failure and the Reset Operation

10

If the Startup Configuration File specifies a static Smartport type, the Smartport type of the interface is set to this static type. If the Startup Configuration File specifies a Smartport type that was dynamically assigned by Auto Smartport: If the Auto Smartport Global Operational state, the interface Auto Smartport state, and the Persistent Status are all Enable, the Smartport type is set to this dynamic type. Else the corresponding anti-macro is applied and the interfaces status is set to Default.

Macro Failure and the Reset Operation


A Smartport macro might fail if there is a conflict between the existing configuration of the interface and a Smartport macro. When a Smartport macro fails, a SYSLOG message containing the following parameters is sent: Port number Smartport type The line number of the failed CLI command in the macro

When a Smartport macro fails on an interface, the status of the interface is set to Unknown. The reason for the failure can be displayed in the Interface Settings page, Show Diagnostics popup. After the source of the problem is determined and the existing configuration or Smartport macro is corrected, you must perform a reset operation to reset the interface before it can be reapplied with a Smartport type (in the Interface Settings pages). See the workflow area in Common Smartport Tasks section for troubleshooting tips.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

126

10
How the Smartport Feature Works

Smartport
How the Smartport Feature Works

You can apply a Smartport macro to an interface by the Smartport type associated with the macro. Because support is provided for Smartport types which correspond to devices that do not allow themselves to be discovered via CDP and/or LLDP, these Smartport types must be statically assigned to the desired interfaces. This can be done by navigating to the Smartport Interface Settings page, selecting the radio button of the desired interface, and clicking Edit . Then, select the Smartport type you want to assign and adjust the parameters as necessary before clicking Apply. There are two ways to apply a Smartport macro by Smartport type to an interface: Static Smartport You manually assign a Smartport type to an interface. The corresponding Smartport macro is applied to the interface. You can manually assign a Smartport type to an interface from the Smartport Interface Settings Page. Auto Smartport When a device is detected from an interface, the Smartport macro, if any, that corresponds to the Smartport type of the attaching device is automatically applied. Auto Smartport is enabled by default globally, and at the interface level. In both cases, the associated anti-macro is run when the Smartport type is removed from the interface, and the anti-macro runs in exactly the same manner, removing all of the interface configuration.

Auto Smartport
In order for Auto Smartport to automatically assign Smartport types to interfaces, the Auto Smartport feature must be enabled globally and on the relevant interfaces which Auto Smartport should be allowed to configure. By default, Auto Smartport is enabled and allowed to configure all interfaces. The Smartport type assigned to each interface is determined by the CDP and LLDP packets received on the each interface respectively. If multiple devices are attached to an interface, a configuration profile that is appropriate for all of the devices is applied to the interface if possible.

127

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Auto Smartport

10
If a device is aged out (no longer receiving advertisements from other devices), the interface configuration is changed according to its Persistent Status. If the Persistent Status is enabled, the interface configuration is retained. If not, the Smartport Type reverts to Default.

Enabling Auto Smartport


Auto Smartport can be enabled globally in the Properties page in the following ways: EnabledThis manually enables Auto Smartport and places it into operation immediately. Enable by Auto Voice VLANThis enables Auto Smartport to operate if Auto Voice VLAN is enabled and in operation. Enable by Auto Voice VLAN is the default.

NOTE In addition to enabling Auto Smartport globally, you must enable Auto Smartport at

the desired interface as well. By default, Auto Smartport is enabled at all the interfaces. See Voice VLAN for more information on enabling Auto Voice VLAN

Identifying Smartport Type


If Auto Smartport is globally enabled (in the Properties page), and at an interface (in the Interface Settings page), the switch applies a Smartport macro to the interface based on the Smartport type of the attaching device. Auto Smartport derives the Smartport types of attaching devices based on the CDP and/or LLDP the devices advertise. If, for example, an IP phone is attached to a port, it transmits CDP or LLDP packets that advertise its capabilities. After reception of these CDP and/or LLDP packets, the switch derives the appropriate Smartport type for phone and applies the corresponding Smartport macro to the interface where the IP phone attaches. Unless Persistent Auto Smartport is enabled on an interface, the Smartport type and resulting configuration applied by Auto Smartport is removed if the attaching device(s) ages out, links down, reboots, or conflicting capabilities are received. Aging out times are determined by the absence of CDP and/or LLDP advertisements from the device for a specified time period.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

128

10
Using CDP/LLDP Information to Identify Smartport Types

Smartport
Auto Smartport

The switch detects the type of device attached to the port, based on the CDP/ LLDP capabilities. This mapping is shown in the following tables: CDP Capabilities Mapping to Smartport Type Capability Name Router TB Bridge SR Bridge Switch Host IGMP conditional filtering Repeater VoIP Phone Remotely-Managed Device CAST Phone Port Two-Port MAC Relay CDP Bit 0x01 0x02 0x04 0x08 0x10 0x20 0x40 0x80 0x100 0x200 0x400 Smartport Type Router Wireless Access Point Ignore Switch Host Ignore Ignore ip_phone Ignore Ignore Ignore

LLDP Capabilities Mapping to Smartport Type Capability Name Other Repeater IETF RFC 2108 MAC Bridge IEEE Std. 802.1D WLAN Access Point IEEE Std. 802.11 MIB Router IETF RFC 1812 Telephone IETF RFC 4293 LLDP Bit 1 2 3 4 5 6 Smartport Type Ignore Ignore Switch Wireless Access Point Router ip_phone

129

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Auto Smartport

10
LLDP Capabilities Mapping to Smartport Type (Continued) Capability Name DOCSIS cable device IETF RFC 4639 and IETF RFC 4546 Station Only IETF RFC 4293 C-VLAN Component of a VLAN Bridge IEEE Std. 802.1Q S-VLAN Component of a VLAN Bridge IEEE Std. 802.1Q Two-port MAC Relay (TPMR) IEEE Std. 802.1Q Reserved LLDP Bit 7 8 9 10 11 12-16 Smartport Type Ignore Host Switch Switch Ignore Ignore

NOTE If only the IP Phone and Host bits are set, then the Smartport type is

ip_phone_desktop.

Multiple Devices Attached to the Port


The switch derives the Smartport type of a connected device via the capabilities the device advertises in its CDP and/or LLDP packets. If multiple devices are connected to the switch through one interface, Auto Smartport considers each capability advertisement it receives through that interface in order to assign the correct Smartport type. The assignment is based on the following algorithm: If all devices on an interface advertise the same capability (there is no conflict) the matching Smartport type is applied to the interface. If one of the devices is a switch, the Switch Smartport type is used. If one of the devices is an AP, the Wireless Access Point Smartport type is used. If one of the devices is an IP phone and another device is a host, the ip_phone_desktop Smartport type is used. If one of the devices is an IP phone desktop and the other is an IP phone or host, the ip_phone_desktop Smartport type is used. In all other cases the default Smartport type is used.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

130

10

Smartport
Error Handling

For more information about LLDP/CDP refer to the Configuring LLDP and Configuring CDP sections, respectively.

Persistent Auto Smartport Interface


If the Persistent status of an interface is enabled, its Smartport type and the configuration that is already applied dynamically by Auto Smartport remains on the interface even after the attaching device ages out, the interface goes down, and the switch is rebooted (assuming the configuration was saved). The Smartport type and the configuration of the interface are not changed unless Auto Smartport detects an attaching device with a different Smartport type. If the Persistent status of an interface is disabled, the interface reverts to the default Smartport type when the attaching device to it ages out, the interface goes down, or the switch is rebooted. Enabling Persistent status on an interface eliminates the device detection delay that otherwise occurs.
NOTE The persistence of the Smartport types applied to the interfaces are effective

between reboots only if the running configuration with the Smartport type applied at the interfaces is saved to the startup configuration file.

Error Handling
When a smart port macro fails to apply to an interface, you can examine the point of the failure in the Interface Settings page and reset the port and reapply the macro after the error is corrected from the Interface Settings and Interface Settings Edit pages.

Default Configuration
Smartport is always available. By default, Auto Smartport is enabled by Auto Voice VLAN, relies on both CDP and LLDP to detect attaching device's Smartport type, and detects Smartport type IP phone, IP phone + Desktop, Switch, and Wireless Access Point. See Voice VLAN for a description of the voice factory defaults.

131

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Relationships with Other Features and Backwards Compatibility

10

Relationships with Other Features and Backwards Compatibility


Auto Smartport is enabled by default and may be disabled. Telephony OUI cannot function concurrently with Auto Smartport, and Auto Voice VLAN. Auto Smartport must be disabled before enabling Telephony OUI.

Common Smartport Tasks


This section describes some common tasks to setup Smartport and Auto Smartport.

Workflow1: To globally enable Auto Smartport on the switch, and to configure a port with Auto Smartport, perform the following steps:
STEP 1 To enable the Auto Smartport feature on the switch, open the Smartport >

Properties page. Set Administrative Auto Smartport to Enable or Enable by Voice VLAN.
STEP 2 Select whether the switch is to process CDP and/or LLDP advertisements from

connected devices.
STEP 3 Select which type of devices are to be detected in the Auto Smartport Device

Detection field.
STEP 4 Click Apply STEP 5 To enable the Auto Smartport feature on one or more interfaces, open the

Smartport > Interface Settings page.


STEP 6 Select the interface, and click Edit. STEP 7 Select Auto Smartport in the Smartport Application field. STEP 8 Check or uncheck Persistent Status if desired. STEP 9 Click Apply.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

132

10

Smartport
Common Smartport Tasks

Workflow2: To configure an interface as a static Smartport, perform the following steps:


STEP 1 To enable the Smartport feature on the interface, open the Smartport > Interface

Settings page.
STEP 2 Select the interface, and click Edit. STEP 3 Select the Smartport type that is to be assigned to the interface in the Smartport

Application field.
STEP 4 Set the macro parameters as required. STEP 5 Click Apply.

Workflow3: To adjust Smartport macro parameter defaults, perform the following steps:
Through this procedure you can accomplish the following: View the macro source. Change parameter defaults. Restore the parameter defaults to the factory settings.

1. Open the Smartport > Smartport Type Settings page. 2. Select the Smartport Type. 3. Click View Macro Source to view the current Smartport macro that is associated with the selected Smartport Type. 4. Click Edit to open a new window in which you can modify the default values of the parameters in the macros bound to that Smartport type. These parameter default values are used when Auto Smartport applies the selected Smartport type (if applicable) to an interface. 5. In the Edit page, modify the fields. 6. Click Apply to rerun the macro if the parameters were changed, or Restore Defaults to restore default parameter values to built-in macros if required.

133

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Configuring Smartport Using The Web-based Interface

10

Workflow4: To rerun a Smartport macro after it has failed, perform the following steps:
STEP 1 In the Interface Settings page, select an interface with Smartport type Unknown. STEP 2 Click Show Diagnostics to see the problem. STEP 3 Troubleshoot, then correct the problem. Consider the troubleshooting tip below. STEP 4 Click Edit. A new window appears in which you can click Reset to reset the

interface.
STEP 5 Return to the main page and reapply the macro using either Reapply (for devices

that are not switches, routers or APs) or Reapply Smartport Macro (for switches, routers or APs) to run the Smartport Macro on the interface. A second method of resetting single or multiple unknown interfaces is:
STEP 1 In the Interface Settings page, select the Port Type equals to checkbox. STEP 2 Select Unknown and click Go. STEP 3 Click Reset All Unknown Smartports. Then reapply the macro as described above.

TIP

The reason that the macro failed might be a conflict with a configuration on the interface made prior to applying the macro (most often encountered with security and storm-control settings), a wrong port type, a typo or an incorrect command within the user-defined macro, or an invalid parameter setting. Parameters are checked for neither type nor boundary prior to the attempt to apply the macro, therefore, an incorrect or invalid input to a parameter value will almost assuredly cause failure when applying the macro.

Configuring Smartport Using The Web-based Interface


The Smartport feature is configured in the Smartport > Properties, Smartport Type Settings and Interface Settings pages. For Voice VLAN configuration, see Voice VLAN. For LLDP/CDP configuration, see the Configuring LLDP and Configuring CDP sections, respectively.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

134

10
Smartport Properties

Smartport
Configuring Smartport Using The Web-based Interface

To configure the Smartport feature globally:


STEP 1 Click Smartport > Properties. The Properties Page appears. STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

Administrative Auto SmartportSelect to globally enable or disable Auto Smartport. The following options are available: -

DisableSelect to disable Auto Smartport on the device. EnableSelect to enable Auto Smartport on the device. Enable by Auto Voice VLANThis enables Auto Smartport, but puts it in
operation only when Auto Voice VLAN is also enabled and in operation. Enable by Auto Voice VLAN is the default.

Auto Smartport Device Detection MethodSelect whether incoming CDP, LLDP, or both types of packets are used to detect the Smartport type of the attaching device(s). At least one must be checked in order for Auto Smartport to identify devices. Operational CDP StatusDisplays the operational status of CDP. Enable CDP if Auto Smartport is to detect the Smartport type based on CDP advertisement. Operational LLDP StatusDisplays the operational status of LLDP. Enable LLDP if Auto Smartport is to detect the Smartport type based on LLDP/ LLDP-MED advertisement. Auto Smartport Device DetectionSelect each type of device for which Auto Smartport can assign Smartport types to interfaces. If unchecked, Auto Smartport does not assign that Smartport type to any interface.

STEP 3 Click Apply. This sets the global Smartport parameters on the switch.

135

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Configuring Smartport Using The Web-based Interface

10

Smartport Type Settings


Use the Smartport Type Settings page to edit the Smartport Type settings and view the Macro Source. By default, each Smartport type is associated with a pair of built-in Smartport macros. See Smartport Types for further information on macro versus anti-macro. Built-in or user-defined macros can have parameters. The built-in macros have up to three parameters. Editing these parameters for the Smartport types applied by Auto Smartport from the Smartport Type Settings page configures the default values for these parameters. These defaults are used by Auto Smartport.
NOTE Changes to Auto Smartport types cause the new settings to be applied to

interfaces which have already been assigned that type by Auto Smartport. In this case, binding an invalid macro or setting an invalid default parameter value causes all ports of this Smartport type to become unknown.
STEP 1 Click Smartport > Smartport Type Settings . The Smartport Type Settings page

appears.
STEP 2 To view the Smartport macro associated with a Smartport type, select a

Smartport type and click View Macro Source.


STEP 3 To modify the parameters of a macro, select a Smartport type and click Edit . The

Edit Smartport Type Settings page appears.


STEP 4 Enter the fields.

Port TypeSelect a Smartport type. Macro NameDisplays the name of the Smartport macro currently associated with the Smartport type. Macro ParametersDisplays the following fields for three parameters in the macro: Parameter NameName of parameter in macro. Parameter ValueCurrent value of parameter in macro. This can be changed here. Parameter DescriptionDescription of parameter.

You can restore the default parameter values by clicking Restore Defaults.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

136

10

Smartport
Configuring Smartport Using The Web-based Interface

STEP 5 Click Apply to save the changes to the running configuration. If the Smartport

macro and/or its parameter values associated with the Smartport type are modified, Auto Smartport automatically reapplies the macro to the interfaces currently assigned with the Smartport type by Auto Smartport. Auto Smartport does not apply the changes to interfaces that were statically assigned a Smartport type.
NOTE There is no method to validate macro parameters because they do not have a type

association. Therefore, any entry is valid at this point. However, invalid parameter values may cause errors to occur when the Smartport type is assigned to an interface, applying the associated macro.

Smartport Interface Settings


Use the Interface Settings page to perform the following tasks: Statically apply a specific Smartport type to an interface with interface specific values for the macro parameters. Enable Auto Smartport on an interface. Diagnose a Smartport macro that failed upon application, and caused the Smartport type to become Unknown. Reapply a Smartport macro after it fails for one of the following types of interfaces: switch, router and AP. It is expected that the necessary corrections have been made prior to clicking Reapply. See the workflow area in Common Smartport Tasks section for troubleshooting tips. Reapply a Smartport macro to an interface. In some circumstances, you may want to reapply a Smartport macro so that the configuration at an interface is up to date. For instance, reapplying a switch Smartport macro at a switch interface makes the interface a member of the VLANs created since the last macro application. You have to be familiar with the current configurations on the switch and the definition of the macro to determine if a reapplication has any impact on the interface. Reset unknown interfaces. This sets the mode of Unknown interfaces to Default.

137

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Configuring Smartport Using The Web-based Interface

10

To apply a Smartport macro:


STEP 1 Click Smartport > Interface Settings. The Interface Settings page appears.

Reapply the associated Smartport macro in the following ways: Select a group of Smartport types (switches, routers or APs) and click Reapply Smartport Macro. The macros are applied to all selected interface types. Select an interface that is UP and click Reapply to reapply the last macro that was applied to the interface. The Reapply action also adds the interface to all newly-created VLANs.
STEP 2 Smartport Diagnostic.

If a Smartport macro fails, the Smartport Type of the interface is Unknown. Select an interface which is of unknown type and click Show Diagnostic. This displays the command at which application of the macro failed. See the workflow area in Common Smartport Tasks section for troubleshooting tips. Proceed to reapply the macro after correcting the problem.
STEP 3 Resetting all Unknown interfaces to Default type.

Select the Port Type equals to checkbox. Select Unknown and click Go. Click Reset All Unknown Smartports. Then reapply the macro as described above. This performs a reset on all interfaces with type Unknown, meaning that all interfaces are returned to the Default type. After correcting the error in the macro or on the current interface configuration or both, a new macro may be applied.

NOTE Resetting the interface of unknown type does not reset the configuration

performed by the macro that failed. This clean up must be done manually. To assign a Smartport type to an interface or activate Auto Smartport on the interface:
STEP 1 Select an interface and click Edit . The Edit Interface Settings page appears. STEP 2 Enter the fields.

InterfaceSelect the port or LAG.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

138

10

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

Smartport TypeDisplays the Smartport type currently assigned to the port/LAG. Smartport ApplicationSelect the Smartport type from the Smartport Application pull-down. Smartport Application Method If Auto Smartport is selected, Auto Smartport automatically assigns the Smartport type based on the CDP and/ or LLDP advertisement received from the connecting devices as well as applying the corresponding Smartport macro. To statically assign a Smartport type and apply the corresponding Smartport macro to the interface, select the desired Smartport type. Persistent StatusSelect to enable the Persistent status. If enabled, the association of a Smartport type to an interface remains even if the interface goes down, or the switch is rebooted. Persistent is applicable only if the Smartport Application of the interface is Auto Smartport. Enabling Persistent at an interface eliminates the device detection delay that otherwise occurs. Macro ParametersDisplays the following fields for up to three parameters in the macro: Parameter NameName of parameter in macro. Parameter ValueCurrent value of parameter in macro. This can be changed here. Parameter DescriptionDescription of parameter.

STEP 3 Click Reset to set an interface to Default if it is in Unknown status (as a result of an

unsuccessful macro application). The macro can be reapplied on the main page.
STEP 4 Click Apply to update the changes and assign the Smartport type to the interface.

Built-in Smartport Macros


The following describes the pair of built-in macros for each Smartport type. For each Smartport type there is a macro to configure the interface and an anti macro to remove the configuration. Macro code for the following Smartport types are provided: desktop printer

139

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

10
guest server host ip_camera ip_phone ip_phone_desktop switch router ap

desktop
[desktop] #interface configuration, for increased network security and reliability when connecting a desktop device, such as a PC, to a switch port. #macro description Desktop #macro keywords $native_vlan $max_hosts # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port # $max_hosts: The maximum number of allowed devices on the port #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN #$max_hosts = 10 # #the port type cannot be detected automatically # #the default mode is trunk smartport switchport trunk native vlan $native_vlan # port security max $max_hosts port security mode max-addresses port security discard trap 60 # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control include-multicast smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree portfast # @

no_desktop

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

140

10
[no_desktop] #macro description No Desktop # no smartport switchport trunk native vlan smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove all # no port security no port security mode no port security max # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable no smartport storm-control broadcast level no smartport storm-control include-multicast # spanning-tree portfast auto # @

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

printer
[printer] #macro description printer #macro keywords $native_vlan # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN # #the port type cannot be detected automatically # switchport mode access switchport access vlan $native_vlan # #single host port security max 1 port security mode max-addresses port security discard trap 60 # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control include-multicast smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree portfast # @

no_printer
[no_printer] #macro description No printer

141

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

10
# no switchport access vlan no switchport mode # no port security no port security mode # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable no smartport storm-control broadcast level no smartport storm-control include-multicast # spanning-tree portfast auto # @

guest
[guest] #macro description guest #macro keywords $native_vlan # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN # #the port type cannot be detected automatically # switchport mode access switchport access vlan $native_vlan # #single host port security max 1 port security mode max-addresses port security discard trap 60 # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control include-multicast smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree portfast # @

no_guest]]
[no_guest] #macro description No guest # no switchport access vlan no switchport mode

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

142

10
# no port security no port security mode # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable no smartport storm-control broadcast level no smartport storm-control include-multicast # spanning-tree portfast auto # @

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

server
[server] #macro description server #macro keywords $native_vlan $max_hosts # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port # $max_hosts: The maximum number of allowed devices on the port #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN #$max_hosts = 10 # #the port type cannot be detected automatically # #the default mode is trunk smartport switchport trunk native vlan $native_vlan # port security max $max_hosts port security mode max-addresses port security discard trap 60 # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree portfast # @

no_server
[no_server] #macro description No server # no smartport switchport trunk native vlan smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove all # no port security

143

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

10
no port security mode no port security max # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable no smartport storm-control broadcast level # spanning-tree portfast auto # @

host
[host] #macro description host #macro keywords $native_vlan $max_hosts # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port # $max_hosts: The maximum number of allowed devices on the port #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN #$max_hosts = 10 # #the port type cannot be detected automatically # #the default mode is trunk smartport switchport trunk native vlan $native_vlan # port security max $max_hosts port security mode max-addresses port security discard trap 60 # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control include-multicast smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree portfast # @

no_host
[no_host] #macro description No host # no smartport switchport trunk native vlan smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove all # no port security no port security mode

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

144

10
no port security max # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable no smartport storm-control broadcast level no smartport storm-control include-multicast # spanning-tree portfast auto # @

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

ip_camera
[ip_camera] #macro description ip_camera #macro keywords $native_vlan # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN # switchport mode access switchport access vlan $native_vlan # #single host port security max 1 port security mode max-addresses port security discard trap 60 # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control include-multicast smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree portfast # @

no_ip_camera
[no_ip_camera] #macro description No ip_camera # no switchport access vlan no switchport mode # no port security no port security mode # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable no smartport storm-control broadcast level no smartport storm-control include-multicast

145

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

10
# spanning-tree portfast auto # @

ip_phone
[ip_phone] #macro description ip_phone #macro keywords $native_vlan $voice_vlan $max_hosts # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port # $voice_vlan: The voice VLAN ID # $max_hosts: The maximum number of allowed devices on the port #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN #$voice_vlan = 1 #$max_hosts = 10 # #the default mode is trunk smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan add $voice_vlan smartport switchport trunk native vlan $native_vlan # port security max $max_hosts port security mode max-addresses port security discard trap 60 # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control include-multicast smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree portfast # @

no_ip_phone
[no_ip_phone] #macro description no ip_phone #macro keywords $voice_vlan # #macro key description: $voice_vlan: The voice VLAN ID # #Default Values are #$voice_vlan = 1 # smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove $voice_vlan no smartport switchport trunk native vlan smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove all

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

146

10
# no port security no port security mode no port security max # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable no smartport storm-control broadcast level no smartport storm-control include-multicast # spanning-tree portfast auto # @

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

ip_phone_desktop
[ip_phone_desktop] #macro description ip_phone_desktop #macro keywords $native_vlan $voice_vlan $max_hosts # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port # $voice_vlan: The voice VLAN ID # $max_hosts: The maximum number of allowed devices on the port #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN #$voice_vlan = 1 #$max_hosts = 10 # #the default mode is trunk smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan add $voice_vlan smartport switchport trunk native vlan $native_vlan # port security max $max_hosts port security mode max-addresses port security discard trap 60 # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control include-multicast smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree portfast # @

no_ip_phone_desktop
[no_ip_phone_desktop] #macro description no ip_phone_desktop #macro keywords $voice_vlan #

147

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

10
#macro key description: $voice_vlan: The voice VLAN ID # #Default Values are #$voice_vlan = 1 # smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove $voice_vlan no smartport switchport trunk native vlan smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove all # no port security no port security mode no port security max # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable no smartport storm-control broadcast level no smartport storm-control include-multicast # spanning-tree portfast auto # @

switch
[switch] #macro description switch #macro keywords $native_vlan $voice_vlan # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port # $voice_vlan: The voice VLAN ID #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN #$voice_vlan = 1 # #the default mode is trunk smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan add all smartport switchport trunk native vlan $native_vlan # spanning-tree link-type point-to-point # @

no_switch
[no_switch] #macro description No switch #macro keywords $voice_vlan # #macro key description: $voice_vlan: The voice VLAN ID # no smartport switchport trunk native vlan

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

148

10
smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove all # no spanning-tree link-type # @

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

router
[router] #macro description router #macro keywords $native_vlan $voice_vlan # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port # $voice_vlan: The voice VLAN ID # #Default Values are #$native_vlan = Default VLAN #$voice_vlan = 1 # #the default mode is trunk smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan add all smartport switchport trunk native vlan $native_vlan # smartport storm-control broadcast level 10 smartport storm-control broadcast enable # spanning-tree link-type point-to-point # @

no_router
[no_router] #macro description No router #macro keywords $voice_vlan # #macro key description: $voice_vlan: The voice VLAN ID # no smartport switchport trunk native vlan smartport switchport trunk allowed vlan remove all # no smartport storm-control broadcast enable

149

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Smartport
Built-in Smartport Macros

10
no smartport storm-control broadcast level # no spanning-tree link-type # @

ap
[ap] #macro description ap #macro keywords $native_vlan $voice_vlan # #macro key description: $native_vlan: The untag VLAN which will be configured on the port

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

150

11
Port Management: PoE
The Power over Ethernet (PoE) feature is only available on PoE-based devices. For a list of PoE-based devices, refer to the Switch Models section. This section describes how to use the PoE feature. It covers the following topics: PoE on the Switch Configuring PoE Properties Configuring PoE Settings

PoE on the Switch


A PoE switch is PSE (Power Sourcing Equipment) that delivers electrical power to connected PD (Powered Devices) over existing copper cables without interfering with the network traffic, updating the physical network or modifying the network infrastructure. See Switch Models for information concerning PoE support on various models.

PoE Features
PoE provides the following features: Eliminates the need to run 110/220 V AC power to all devices on a wired LAN. Removes the necessity for placing all network devices next to power sources. Eliminates the need to deploy double cabling systems in an enterprise significantly decreasing installation costs.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

151

Port Management: PoE


PoE on the Switch

11
Power over Ethernet can be used in any enterprise network that deploys relatively low-powered devices connected to the Ethernet LAN, such as: IP phones Wireless access points IP gateways Audio and video remote monitoring devices

PoE Operation
PoE implements in the following stages: DetectionSends special pulses on the copper cable. When a PoE device is located at the other end, that device responds to these pulses. ClassificationNegotiation between the Power Sourcing Equipment (PSE) and the Powered Device (PD) commences after the Detection stage. During negotiation, the PD specifies its class, which is the amount of maximum power that the PD consumes. Power ConsumptionAfter the classification stage completes, the PSE provides power to the PD. If the PD supports PoE, but without classification, it is assumed to be class 0 (the maximum). If a PD tries to consume more power than permitted by the standard, the PSE stops supplying power to the port.

PoE supports two modes: Port LimitThe maximum power the switch agrees to supply is limited to the value the system administrator configures, regardless of the Classification result. Class Power LimitThe maximum power the switch agrees to supply is determined by the results of the Classification stage. This means that it is set as per the Client's request.

PoE Configuration Considerations


There are two factors to consider in the PoE feature: The amount of power that the PSE can supply The amount of power that the PD is actually attempting to consume

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

152

11
You can decide the following:

Port Management: PoE


PoE on the Switch

Maximum power a PSE is allowed to supply to a PD During device operation, to change the mode from Class Power Limit to Port Limit and vice versa. The power values per port that were configured for the Port Limit mode are retained.
NOTE Changing the mode from Class Limit to Port limit and vice versa when the device is operational forces the Powered Device to reboot.

Maximum port limit allowed as a per-port numerical limit in mW (Port Limit mode). To generate a trap when a PD tries to consume too much and at what percent of the maximum power this trap is generated.

The PoE-specific hardware automatically detects the PD class and its power limit according to the class of the device connected to each specific port (Class Limit mode). If at any time during the connectivity an attached PD requires more power from the switch than the configured allocation allows (no matter if the switch is in Class Limit or Port Limit mode), the switch does the following: Maintains the up/down status of the PoE port link Turns off power delivery to the PoE port Logs the reason for turning off power Generates a trap to a remote log server

!
CAUTION Consider the following when connecting switches capable of supplying PoE:

The PoE models of the Sx200, Sx300, and Sx500 series switches are PSE (Power Sourcing Equipment) that are capable of supplying DC power to attaching PD (Powered Devices). These devices include VoIP phones, IP cameras, and wireless access points. The PoE switches can detect and supply power to pre-standard legacy PoE Powered Devices. Due to the support of legacy PoE, it is possible that a PoE switch acting as a PSE may mistakenly detect and supply power to an attaching PSE, including other PoE switches, as a legacy PD. Even though Sx200/300/500 PoE switches are PSE, and as such should be powered by AC, they could be powered up as a legacy PD by another PSE due to false detection. When this happens, the PoE switch may not operate properly and

153

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management: PoE


Configuring PoE Properties

11
may not be able to properly supply power to its attaching PDs. To prevent false detection, you should disable PoE on the ports on the PoE switches that are used to connect to PSEs. You should also first power up a PSE device before connecting it to a PoE switch. When a device is being falsely detected as a PD, you should disconnect the device from the PoE port and power recycle the device with AC power before reconnecting its PoE ports.

Configuring PoE Properties


The PoE Properties page enables selecting either the Port Limit or Class Limit PoE mode and specifying the PoE traps to be generated. These settings are entered in advance. When the PD actually connects and is consuming power, it might consume much less than the maximum power allowed. Output power is disabled during power-on reboot, initialization, and system configuration to ensure that PDs are not damaged. To configure PoE on the switch and monitor current power usage:
STEP 1 Click Port Management > PoE > Properties. The PoE Properties page appears. STEP 2 Enter the values for the following fields:

Power ModeSelect one of the following options: -

Port LimitThe maximum power limit per each port is configured by the
user.

Class LimitThe maximum power limit per port is determined by the


class of the device, which results from the Classification stage.

NOTE When you change from Port Limit to Class Limit or vice versa, you

must disable PoE ports, and enable them after changing the power configuration. TrapsEnable or disable a SYSLOG trap. Power Trap ThresholdEnter the usage threshold that is a percentage of the power limit. An alarm is initiated if the power exceeds this value.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

154

11
The following counters are displayed for each device:

Port Management: PoE


Configuring PoE Settings

Nominal PowerThe total amount of power the switch can supply to all the connected PDs. Consumed PowerAmount of power currently being consumed by the PoE ports. Available PowerNominal power minus the amount of consumed power.

STEP 3 Click Apply to save the PoE properties.

Configuring PoE Settings


The PoE Settings page displays system PoE information for enabling PoE on the interfaces and monitoring the current power usage and maximum power limit per port. Click Port Management > PoE > Settings. The Settings page appears. This page limits the power per port in two ways depending on the Power Mode: Port Limit: Power is limited to a specified wattage. For these settings to be active, the system must be in PoE Port Limit mode. That mode is configured in the PoE Properties page. When the power consumed on the port exceeds the port limit, the port power is turned off. Class Limit: Power is limited based on the class of the connected PD. For these settings to be active, the system must be in PoE Class Limit mode. That mode is configured in the PoE Properties page. When the power consumed on the port exceeds the class limit, the port power is turned off.

PoE priority example:


Given: A 48 port switch is supplying a total of 375 watts. The administrator configures all ports to allocate up to 30 watts. This results in 48 times 30 ports equaling 1440 watts, which is too much. The switch cannot provide enough power to each port, so it provides power according to the priority.

155

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management: PoE


Configuring PoE Settings

11
The administrator sets the priority for each port, allocating how much power it can be given. These priorities are entered in the PoE Settings page. See Switch Models for a description of the switch models that support PoE and the maximum power that can be allocated to PoE ports. To configure PoE port settings:

STEP 1 Click Port Management > PoE > Settings. The Settings page appears. The list of

fields below is for Port Limit Power Mode. The fields are slightly different if the Power Mode is Class Limit.
STEP 2 Select a port and click Edit. The Edit PoE Settings page appears. The list of fields

below is for Port Limit Power Mode. The fields are slightly different if the Power Mode is Class Limit.
STEP 3 Enter the value for the following field:

InterfaceSelect the port to configure. PoE Administrative StatusEnable or disable PoE on the port. Power Priority LevelSelect the port priority: low, high, or critical, for use when the power supply is low. For example, if the power supply is running at 99% usage and port 1 is prioritized as high, but port 3 is prioritized as low, port 1 receives power and port 3 might be denied power. Administrative Power AllocationThis field appears only if the Power Mode set in the PoE Properties page is Port Limit. If the Power mode is Power Limit, enter the power in milliwatts allocated to the port. Max Power AllocationDisplays the maximum amount of power permitted on this port. ClassThis field appears only if the Power Mode set in the PoE Properties page is Class Limit. The class determines the power level: Class 0 1 2 3 Maximum Power Delivered by Switch Port 15.4 watt 4.0 watt 7.0 watt 15.4 watt

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

156

11
Class 4 30.0 watt

Port Management: PoE


Configuring PoE Settings

Maximum Power Delivered by Switch Port

Power ConsumptionDisplays the amount of power in milliwatts assigned to the powered device connected to the selected interface. Overload CounterDisplays the total number of power overload occurrences. Short CounterDisplays the total number of power shortage occurrences. Denied CounterDisplays number of times the powered device was denied power. Absent CounterDisplays the number of times that power was stopped to the powered device, because the powered device was no longer detected. Invalid Signature CounterDisplays the times an invalid signature was received. Signatures are the means by which the powered device identifies itself to the PSE. Signatures are generated during powered device detection, classification, or maintenance.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The PoE settings for the port are written to the Running Configuration

file.

157

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Port Management: PoE


Configuring PoE Settings

11

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

158

12
VLAN Management
This section covers the following topics: VLANs Configuring Default VLAN Settings Creating VLANs Configuring VLAN Interface Settings Defining VLAN Membership Voice VLAN

VLANs
A VLAN is a logical group of ports that enables devices associated with it to communicate with each other over the Ethernet MAC layer, regardless of the physical LAN segment of the bridged network to which they are connected. VLAN Description Each VLAN is configured with a unique VID (VLAN ID) with a value from 1 to 4094. A port on a device in a bridged network is a member of a VLAN if it can send data to and receive data from the VLAN. A port is an untagged member of a VLAN if all packets destined for that port into the VLAN have no VLAN tag. A port is a tagged member of a VLAN if all packets destined for that port into the VLAN have a VLAN tag. A port can be a member of one untagged VLAN and can be a member of several tagged VLANs. A port in VLAN Access mode can be part of only one VLAN. If it is in General or Trunk mode, the port can be part of one or more VLANs.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

159

VLAN Management
VLANs

12
VLANs address security and scalability issues. Traffic from a VLAN stays within the VLAN, and terminates at devices in the VLAN. It also eases network configuration by logically connecting devices without physically relocating those devices. If a frame is VLAN-tagged, a four-byte VLAN tag is added to each Ethernet frame. The tag contains a VLAN ID between 1 and 4094, and a VLAN Priority Tag (VPT) between 0 and 7. See Quality of Service for details about VPT. When a frame enters a VLAN-aware device, it is classified as belonging to a VLAN, based on the four-byte VLAN tag in the frame. If there is no VLAN tag in the frame or the frame is priority-tagged only, the frame is classified to the VLAN based on the PVID (Port VLAN Identifier) configured at the ingress port where the frame is received. The frame is discarded at the ingress port if Ingress Filtering is enabled and the ingress port is not a member of the VLAN to which the packet belongs. A frame is regarded as priority-tagged only if the VID in its VLAN tag is 0. Frames belonging to a VLAN remain within the VLAN. This is achieved by sending or forwarding a frame only to egress ports that are members of the target VLAN. An egress port may be a tagged or untagged member of a VLAN. The egress port: Adds a VLAN tag to the frame if the egress port is a tagged member of the target VLAN, and the original frame does not have a VLAN tag. Removes the VLAN tag from the frame if the egress port is an untagged member of the target VLAN, and the original frame has a VLAN tag.

VLAN Roles All VLAN traffic (Unicast/Broadcast/Multicast) remains within its VLAN. Devices attached to different VLANs do not have direct connectivity to each other over the Ethernet MAC layer. Device VLANs can only be created statically. Some VLANs can have additional roles, including: Voice VLAN: For more information refer to the Voice VLAN section. Guest VLAN: Set in the Edit VLAN Authentication page. Default VLAN: For more information refer to the Configuring Default VLAN Settings section.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

160

12
QinQ

VLAN Management
VLANs

Management VLAN: For more information refer to the Configuring IP Information section.

QinQ provides isolation between service provider networks and customers' networks. The switch is a provider bridge that supports port-based c-tagged service interface. With QinQ, the switch adds an ID tag known as Service Tag (S-tag) to forward traffic over the network. The S-tag is used to segregate traffic between various customers, while preserving the customer VLAN tags. Customer traffic is encapsulated with an S-tag with TPID 0x8100, regardless of whether it was originally c-tagged or untagged. The S-tag allows this traffic to be treated as an aggregate within a provider bridge network, where the bridging is based on the S-tag VID (S-VID) only. The S-Tag is preserved while traffic is forwarded through the network service provider's infrastructure, and is later removed by an egress device. An additional benefit of QinQ is that there is no need to configure customers' edge devices. QinQ is enabled in the VLAN Management > Interface Settings page. VLAN Configuration Workflow To configure VLANs: 1. If required, change the default VLAN by using the Configuring Default VLAN Settings section. 2. Create the required VLANs by using the Creating VLANs section. 3. Set the desired VLAN-related configuration for ports and enable QinQ on an interface using the Configuring VLAN Interface Settings section. 4. Assign interfaces to VLANs by using the Configuring Port to VLAN section or the Configuring VLAN Membership section. 5. View the current VLAN port membership for all the interfaces in the Configuring VLAN Membership section.

161

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Configuring Default VLAN Settings

12

Configuring Default VLAN Settings


When using factory default settings, the switch automatically creates VLAN 1 as the default VLAN, the default interface status of all ports is Trunk, and all ports are configured as untagged members of the default VLAN. The default VLAN has the following characteristics: It is distinct, non-static/non-dynamic, and all ports are untagged members by default. It cannot be deleted. It cannot be given a label. It cannot be used for any special role, such as unauthenticated VLAN or Voice VLAN. This is only relevant for OUI-enabled voice VLAN. If a port is no longer a member of any VLAN, the switch automatically configures the port as an untagged member of the default VLAN. A port is no longer a member of a VLAN if the VLAN is deleted or the port is removed from the VLAN.

When the VID of the default VLAN is changed, the switch performs the following on all the ports in the VLAN, after saving the configuration and rebooting the switch: Removes VLAN membership of the ports from the original default VLAN (possible only after reboot). Changes the PVID (Port VLAN Identifier) of the ports to the VID of the new default VLAN. The original default VLAN ID is removed from the switch. To be used, it must be recreated. Adds the ports as untagged VLAN members of the new default VLAN.

To change the default VLAN:


STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Default VLAN Settings. The Default VLAN Settings

page appears.
STEP 2 Enter the value for the following field:

Current Default VLAN IDDisplays the current default VLAN ID.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

162

12

STEP 3 Click Apply.

VLAN Management
Creating VLANs

Default VLAN ID After RebootEnter a new VLAN ID to replace the default VLAN ID after reboot.

STEP 4 Click Save (in the upper-right corner of the window) and save the Running

Configuration to the Startup Configuration. The Default VLAN ID After Reset becomes the Current Default VLAN ID after you reboot the switch.

Creating VLANs
You can create a VLAN, but this has no effect until the VLAN is attached to at least one port, either manually or dynamically. Ports must always belong to one or more VLANs. The 200 Series switch supports up to 256 VLANs, including the default VLAN. Each VLAN must be configured with a unique VID (VLAN ID) with a value from 1 to 4094. The switch reserves VID 4095 as the Discard VLAN. All packets classified to the Discard VLAN are discarded at ingress, and are not forwarded to a port. To create a VLAN:
STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Create VLAN. The Create VLAN page appears.

The Create VLAN page contains the following fields for all VLANs: VLAN IDUser-defined VLAN ID. VLAN NameUser-defined VLAN name. TypeVLAN type: StaticVLAN is user-defined. DefaultVLAN is the default VLAN.

STEP 2 Click Add to add a new VLAN or select an existing VLAN and click Edit to modify

the VLAN parameters. The Add/Edit VLAN page appears.

163

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Configuring VLAN Interface Settings

12

The page enables the creation of either a single VLAN or a range of VLANs.
STEP 3 To create a single VLAN, select the VLAN radio button, enter the VLAN ID (VID),

and optionally the VLAN Name. To create a range of VLANs, select the Range radio button, and specify the range of VLANs to be created by entering the Starting VID and Ending VID, inclusive. When using the Range function, the maximum number of VLANs you can create at one time is 100.
STEP 4 Click Apply to create the VLAN(s).

Configuring VLAN Interface Settings


The Interface Settings page displays and enables configuration of VLAN-related parameters for all interfaces. To configure the VLAN settings:
STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Interface Settings. The Interface Settings page

appears.
STEP 2 Select an interface type (Port or LAG), and click Go. Ports or LAGs and their VLAN

parameters are displayed.


STEP 3 To configure a Port or LAG, select it and click Edit. The Edit Interface Setting page

appears.
STEP 4 Enter the values for the following fields:

InterfaceSelect a Port/LAG. Interface VLAN ModeSelect the interface mode for the VLAN. The options are: GeneralThe interface can support all functions as defined in the IEEE 802.1q specification. The interface can be a tagged or untagged member of one or more VLANs. AccessThe interface is an untagged member of a single VLAN. A port configured in this mode is known as an access port.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

164

12
-

VLAN Management
Defining VLAN Membership

TrunkThe interface is an untagged member of one VLAN at most, and is a tagged member of zero or more VLANs. A port configured in this mode is known as a trunk port. CustomerSelecting this option places the interface in QinQ mode. This enables you to use your own VLAN arrangements (PVID) across the provider network. The switch is in Q-in-Q mode when it has one or more customer ports. See QinQ.

Administrative PVIDEnter the Port VLAN ID (PVID) of the VLAN to which incoming untagged and priority tagged frames are classified. The possible values are 1 to 4094. Frame TypeSelect the type of frame that the interface can receive. Frames that are not of the configured frame type are discarded at ingress. These frame types are only available in General mode. Possible values are: Admit AllThe interface accepts all types of frames: untagged frames, tagged frames, and priority tagged frames. Admit Tagged OnlyThe interface accepts only tagged frames. Admit Untagged OnlyThe interface accepts only untagged and priority frames.

Ingress Filtering(Available only in General mode) Select to enable ingress filtering. When an interface is ingress filtering enabled, the interface discards all incoming frames that are classified as VLANs of which the interface is not a member. Ingress filtering can be disabled or enabled on general ports. It is always enabled on access ports and trunk ports.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The parameters are written to the Running Configuration file.

Defining VLAN Membership


The Port to VLAN and Port VLAN Membership pages display the VLAN memberships of the ports in various presentations. You can use them to add or remove memberships to or from the VLANs. When a port is forbidden default VLAN membership, that port is not allowed membership in any other VLAN. An internal VID of 4095 is assigned to the port.

165

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Defining VLAN Membership

12
To forward packets properly, intermediate VLAN-aware devices that carry VLAN traffic along the path between end nodes must be manually configured. Untagged port membership between two VLAN-aware devices with no intervening VLAN-aware devices, must be to the same VLAN. In other words, the PVID on the ports between the two devices must be the same if the ports are to send and receive untagged packets to and from the VLAN. Otherwise, traffic might leak from one VLAN to another. Frames that are VLAN-tagged can pass through other network devices that are VLAN-aware or VLAN-unaware. If a destination end node is VLAN-unaware, but is to receive traffic from a VLAN, then the last VLAN-aware device (if there is one), must send frames of the destination VLAN to the end node untagged.

Configuring Port to VLAN


Use the Port to VLAN page to display and configure the ports within a specific VLAN. To map ports or LAGs to a VLAN:
STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Port to VLAN. The Port to VLAN page appears. STEP 2 Select a VLAN and the interface type (Port or LAG), and click Go to display or to

change the port characteristic with respect to the VLAN. The port mode for each port or LAG appears with its current port mode (Access, Trunk or General) configured from the Interface Settings page. Each port or LAG appears with its current registration to the VLAN.
STEP 3 Change the registration of an interface to the VLAN by selecting the desired

option from the following list: ForbiddenThe interface is not allowed to join the VLAN. When a port is not a member of any other VLAN, enabling this option on the port makes the port part of internal VLAN 4095 (a reserved VID). ExcludedThe interface is currently not a member of the VLAN. This is the default for all the ports and LAGs when the VLAN is newly created. TaggedThe interface is a tagged member of the VLAN. UntaggedThe interface is an untagged member of the VLAN. Frames of the VLAN are sent untagged to the interface VLAN.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

166

12

VLAN Management
Defining VLAN Membership

PVIDSelect to set the PVID of the interface to the VID of the VLAN. PVID is a per-port setting.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The interfaces are assigned to the VLAN, and written to the Running

Configuration file. You can continue to display and/or configure port membership of another VLAN by selecting another VLAN ID.

Configuring VLAN Membership


The Port VLAN Membership page displays all ports on the device along with a list of VLANs to which each port belongs. If the port-based authentication method for an interface is 802.1x and the Administrative Port Control is Auto, then: Until the port is authenticated, it is excluded from all VLANs, except guest and unauthenticated ones. In the VLAN to Port page, the port is marked with P. When the port is authenticated, it receives membership in the VLAN in which it was configured.

To assign a port to one or more VLANs:


STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Port VLAN Membership. The Port VLAN

Membership page appears.


STEP 2 Select interface type (Port or LAG), and click Go. The following fields are

displayed for all interfaces of the selected type: InterfacePort/LAG ID. ModeInterface VLAN mode that was selected in the Interface Settings page. Administrative VLANsDrop-down list that displays all VLANs of which the interface might be a member. Operational VLANsDrop-down list that displays all VLANs of which the interface is currently a member. LAGIf interface selected is Port, displays the LAG in which it is a member.

STEP 3 Select a port, and click the Join VLAN button. The Join VLAN page appears.

167

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

12
InterfaceSelect a Port or LAG. ModeDisplays the port VLAN mode that was selected in the Interface Settings page. Select VLANTo associate a port with a VLAN(s), move the VLAN ID(s) from the left list to the right list by using the arrow buttons. The default VLAN might appear in the right list if it is tagged, but it cannot be selected. TaggingSelect one of the following tagging/PVID options: ForbiddenThe interface is not allowed to join the VLAN. When a port is not a member of any other VLAN, enabling this option on the port makes the port part of internal VLAN 4095 (a reserved VID). ExcludedThe interface is currently not a member of the VLAN. This is the default for all the ports and LAGs when the VLAN is newly created. TaggedSelect whether the port is tagged. This is not relevant for Access ports. UntaggedSelect whether port is untagged. This is not relevant for Access ports. PVIDPort PVID is set to this VLAN. If the interface is in access mode or trunk mode, the switch automatically makes the interface an untagged member of the VLAN. If the interface is in general mode, you must manually configure VLAN membership.

STEP 4 Enter the values for the following fields:

STEP 5 Click Apply. The settings are modified and written to the Running Configuration

file.
STEP 6 To see the administrative and operational VLANs on an interface, click Details.

Voice VLAN
In a LAN, voice devices, such as IP phones, VoIP endpoints, and voice systems are placed into the same VLAN. This VLAN is referred as the voice VLAN. If the voice devices are in different voice VLANs, IP (Layer 3) routers are needed to provide communication. This section covers the following topics:

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

168

12
Voice VLAN Overview Configuring Voice VLAN

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

Voice VLAN Overview


This section covers the following topics: Dynamic Voice VLAN Modes Auto Voice VLAN, Auto Smartports, CDP, and LLDP Voice VLAN QoS Voice VLAN Constraints Voice VLAN Workflows

The following are typical voice deployment scenarios with appropriate configurations: UC3xx/UC5xx hosted: All Cisco phones and VoIP endpoints support this deployment model. For this model, the UC3xx/UC5xx, Cisco phones and VoIP endpoints reside in the same voice VLAN. The voice VLAN of UC3xx/ UC5xx defaults to VLAN 100. Third-party IP PBX-hosted: Cisco SBTG CP-79xx, SPA5xx phones and SPA8800 endpoints support this deployment model. In this model, the VLAN used by the phones is determined by the network configuration. There may or may not be separate voice and data VLANs. The phones and VoIP endpoints register with an on-premise IP PBX. IP Centrex/ITSP hosted: Cisco CP-79xx, SPA5xx phones and SPA8800 endpoints support this deployment model. For this model, the VLAN used by the phones is determined by the network configuration. There may or may not be separate voice and data VLANs. The phones and VoIP endpoints register with an off-premise SIP proxy in the cloud.

From a VLAN perspective, the above models operate in both VLAN-aware and VLAN-unaware environments. In the VLAN-aware environment, the voice VLAN is one of the many VLANs configured in an installation. The VLAN-unaware scenario is equivalent to a VLAN-aware environment with only one VLAN. The switch always operates as a VLAN-aware switch.

169

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

12
The switch supports a single voice VLAN. By default, the voice VLAN is VLAN 1. The voice VLAN is defaulted to VLAN 1. A different voice VLAN can be manually configured. It can also be dynamically learned when Auto Voice VLAN is enabled. Ports can be manually added to the voice VLAN by using basic VLAN configuration described in the Configuring VLAN Interface Setting section, or by manually applying voice-related Smartport macro to the ports. Alternatively, they can be added dynamically if the switch is in Telephony OUI mode, or has Auto Smartports enabled.

Dynamic Voice VLAN Modes


The switch supports two dynamic voice VLAN modes: Telephony OUI (Organization Unique Identifier) mode and Auto Voice VLAN mode. The two modes affect how voice VLAN and/or voice VLAN port memberships are configured. The two modes are mutually exclusive to each other. Telephony OUI In Telephony OUI mode, the voice VLAN must be a manually-configured VLAN, and cannot be the default VLAN. When the switch is in Telephony OUI mode and a port is manually configured as a candidate to join the voice VLAN, the switch dynamically adds the port to the voice VLAN if it receives a packet with a source MAC address matching to one of the configured telephony OUIs. An OUI is the first three bytes of an Ethernet MAC address. For more information about Telephony OUI, see Configuring Telephony OUI. Auto Voice VLAN In Auto Voice VLAN mode, the voice VLAN can be either the default voice VLAN, manually configured, or learned from external devices such as UC3xx/5xx and from switches that advertise voice VLAN in CDP or VSDP. VSDP is a Cisco defined protocol for voice service discovery. Unlike Telephony OUI mode that detects voice devices based on telephony OUI, Auto Voice VLAN mode depends on Auto Smartport to dynamically add the ports to the voice VLAN. Auto Smartport, if enabled, adds a port to the voice VLAN if it detects an attaching device to the port that advertises itself as a phone or media end points through CDP and/or LLDP-MED.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

170

12
Voice End-Points

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

To have a voice VLAN work properly, the voice devices, such as Cisco phones and VoIP endpoints, must be assigned to the voice VLAN where it sends and receives its voice traffic. Some of the possible scenarios are as follows: A phone/endpoint may be statically configured with the voice VLAN. A phone/endpoint may obtain the voice VLAN in the boot file it downloads from a TFTP server. A DHCP server may specify the boot file and the TFTP server when it assigns an IP address to the phone. A phone/endpoint may obtain the voice VLAN information from CDP and LLDP-MED advertisements it receives from their neighbor voice systems and switches.

The switch expects the attaching voice devices to send voice VLAN, tagged packets. On ports where the voice VLAN is also the native VLAN, voice VLAN untagged packets are possible.

Auto Voice VLAN, Auto Smartports, CDP, and LLDP Defaults


By factory defaults, CDP, LLDP, and LLDP-MED on the switch are enabled, auto Smartport mode is enabled, Basic QoS with trusted DSCP is enabled, and all ports are members of default VLAN 1, which is also the default Voice VLAN. In addition, Dynamic Voice VLAN mode is the default to Auto Voice VLAN with enabling based on trigger, and Auto Smartport is the default to be enabled depending on Auto Voice VLAN.

Voice VLAN Triggers


When the Dynamic Voice VLAN mode is Enable Auto Voice VLAN, Auto Voice VLAN becomes operational only if one or more triggers occur. Possible triggers are static voice VLAN configuration, voice VLAN information received in neighbor CDP advertisement, and voice VLAN information received in the Voice VLAN Discovery Protocol (VSDP). If desired, you can activate Auto Voice VLAN immediately without waiting for a trigger. When Auto Smartport is enabled, depending on Auto Voice VLAN mode, Auto Smartport is enabled when Auto Voice VLAN becomes operational. If desired, you can make Auto Smartport independent of Auto Voice VLAN.

171

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

12
supports Auto Voice VLAN out of the box. It also applies to unconfigured switches that have been upgraded to the firmware version that supports Auto Voice VLAN.

NOTE The default configuration list here applies to switches whose firmware version

NOTE The defaults and the voice VLAN triggers are designed to have no effect on any

installations without a voice VLAN and on switches that have already been configured. You may manually disable and enable Auto Voice VLAN and/or Auto Smartport to fit your deployment if needed.

Auto Voice VLAN


Auto Voice VLAN is responsible to maintain the voice VLAN, but depends on Auto Smartport to maintain the voice VLAN port memberships. Auto Voice VLAN performs the following functions when it is in operation: It discovers voice VLAN information in CDP advertisements from directly connected neighbor devices. If multiple neighbor switches and/or routers, such as Cisco Unified Communication (UC) devices, are advertising their voice VLAN, the voice VLAN from the device with the lowest MAC address is used.
NOTE If connecting the switch to a Cisco UC device, you may need to

configure the port on the UC device using the switchport voice vlan command to ensure the UC device advertises its voice VLAN in CDP at the port. It synchronizes the voice VLAN-related parameters with other Auto Voice VLAN-enabled switches, using Voice Service Discovery Protocol (VSDP). The switch always configures itself with the voice VLAN from the highest priority source it is aware of. The priority is based on the source type and MAC address of the source providing the voice VLAN information. Source type priority from high to low are static VLAN configuration, CDP advertisement, and default configuration based on changed default VLAN, and default voice VLAN. A numeric low MAC address is of higher priority than a numeric high MAC address. It maintains the voice VLAN until a new voice VLAN from a higher priority source is discovered or until the Auto Voice VLAN is restarted by the user. When restarted, the switch resets the voice VLAN to the default voice VLAN and restarts the Auto Voice VLAN discovery. When a new voice VLAN is configured/discovered, the switch automatically creates it, and replaces all the port memberships of the existing voice VLAN to the new voice VLAN. This may interrupt or terminate existing voice sessions, which is expected when network topology is altered.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

172

12

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

Auto Smartport works with CDP/LLDP to maintain the port memberships of the voice VLAN when voice end-points are detected from the ports: When CDP and LLDP are enabled, the switch sends out CDP and LLDP packets periodically to advertise the voice VLAN to the voice endpoints to use. When a device attaching to a port advertises itself as a voice endpoint through CDP and/or LLDP, the Auto Smartport automatically adds the port to the voice VLAN by applying the corresponding Smartport macro to the port (if there is no other devices from the port advertising a conflicting or superior capability). If a device advertises itself as a phone, the default Smartport macro is phone. If a device advertises itself as a phone and host or phone and bridge, the default Smartport macro is phone+desktop.

Voice VLAN QoS


Voice VLAN can propagate the CoS/802.1p and DSCP settings by using LLDPMED Network policies. The LLDP-MED is set by default to response with the Voice QoS setting if an appliance sends LLDP-MED packets. MED-supported devices must send their voice traffic with the same CoS/802.1p and DSCP values, as received with the LLDP-MED response. You can disable the automatic update between Voice VLAN and LLDP-MED and use his own network policies. Working with the OUI mode, the switch can additionally configure the mapping and remarking (CoS/802.1p) of the voice traffic based on the OUI. By default, all interfaces are CoS/802.1p trusted. The switch applies the quality of service based on the CoS/802.1p value found in the voice stream. For Telephony OUI voice streams, you can override the quality of service and optionally remark the 802.1p of the voice streams by specifying the desired CoS/802.1p values and using the remarking option under Telephony OUI.

Voice VLAN Constraints


The following constraints exist: Only one Voice VLAN is supported. A VLAN that is defined as a Voice VLAN cannot be removed

In addition the following constraints are applicable for Telephony OUI: The Voice VLAN cannot be VLAN1 (the default VLAN).

173

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

12
The Voice VLAN cannot be Smartport enabled. The Voice VLAN QoS decision has priority over any other QoS decision, except for the Policy decision. A new VLAN ID can be configured for the Voice VLAN only if the current Voice VLAN does not have candidate ports. The interface VLAN of a candidate port must be in General or Trunk mode. The Voice VLAN QoS is applied to candidate ports that have joined the Voice VLAN, and to static ports. The voice flow is accepted if the MAC address can be learned by the Forwarding Database (FDB). (If there is no free space in FDB, no action occurs).

Voice VLAN Workflows


The switch default configuration on Auto Voice VLAN, Auto Smartports, CDP, and LLDP cover most common voice deployment scenarios. This section describes how to deploy voice VLAN when the default configuration does not apply.

Workflow1: To configure Auto Voice VLAN:


STEP 1 Open the VLAN Management > Voice VLAN > Properties page. STEP 2 Select the Voice VLAN ID. It cannot be set to VLAN ID 1 (this step is not required for

dynamic Voice VLAN).


STEP 3 Set Dynamic Voice VLAN to Enable Auto Voice VLAN. STEP 4 Select the Auto Voice VLAN Activation method. NOTE If the device is currently in Telephony OUI mode, you must disable it

before you can configure Auto Voice Vlan


STEP 5 Click Apply. STEP 6 Configure Smartports as described in the Common Smartport Tasks section. STEP 7 Configure LLDP/CDP as described in the Configuring LLDP and Configuring

CDP sections, respectively.


STEP 8 Enable the Smartport feature on the relevant ports using the Smartport > Interface

Settings page.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

174

12
Workflow2: To configure the Telephony OUI Method

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

NOTE Step 7 and Step 8 are optional as they are enabled by default.

STEP 1 Open the VLAN Management > Voice VLAN > Properties page. Set Dynamic Voice

VLAN to Enable Telephony OUI.


NOTE If the device is currently in Auto Voice VLAN mode, you must disable

it before you can enable Telephony OUI.


STEP 2 Configure Telephony OUI in the Telephony OUI page. STEP 3 Configure Telephony OUI VLAN membership for ports in the Telephony OUI

Interface page.

Configuring Voice VLAN


This section describes how to configure voice VLAN. It covers the following topics: Configuring Voice VLAN Properties Displaying Auto Voice VLAN Settings Configuring Telephony OUI

Configuring Voice VLAN Properties


Use the Voice VLAN Properties page for the following: View how voice VLAN is currently configured. Configure the VLAN ID of the Voice VLAN. Configure voice VLAN QoS settings. Configure the voice VLAN mode (Telephony OUI or Auto Voice VLAN). Configure how Auto Voice VLAN is triggered.

175

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

12
To view and configure Voice VLAN properties: appears. The voice VLAN settings configured on the switch are displayed in the Voice VLAN Settings (Administrative Status) block. The voice VLAN settings that are actually being applied to the voice VLAN deployment are displayed in the Voice VLAN Settings (Operational Status) block.

STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Voice VLAN > Properties. The Properties page

STEP 2 Enter values for the following fields:

Voice VLAN IDEnter the VLAN that is to be the Voice VLAN.


NOTE Changes in the voice VLAN ID, CoS/802.1p, and/or DSCP cause the switch to advertise the administrative voice VLAN as a static voice VLAN. If the option Auto Voice VLAN Activation triggered by external Voice VLAN is selected, then the default values need to be maintained.

CoS/802.1p Select a CoS/802.1p value that to be used by LLDP-MED as a voice network policy. Refer to Administration > Discovery > LLDP > LLDP MED Network Policy for additional details. DSCPSelection of DSCP values that to be used by the LLDP-MED as a voice network policy. Refer to Administration > Discovery > LLDP > LLDP MED Network Policy for additional details. Dynamic Voice VLANSelect this field to disable or enable voice VLAN feature in one of the following ways: -

Enable Auto Voice VLANEnable Dynamic Voice VLAN in Auto Voice


VLAN mode.

Enable Telephony OUIEnable Dynamic Voice VLAN in Telephony OUI


mode.

DisableDisable Auto Voice Vlan or Telephony OUI.

Auto Voice VLAN ActivationIf Auto Voice VLAN was enabled, select one of the following options to activate Auto Voice VLAN: -

ImmediateAuto Voice VLAN on the switch is to be activated and put


into operation immediately if enabled.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

176

12
-

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

By External Voice VLAN TriggerAuto Voice VLAN on the switch is


activated and put into operation only if the switch detects a device advertising the voice VLAN.

NOTE Manually re-configuring the voice VLAN ID, CoS/802.1p, and/or DSCP

from their default values results in a static voice VLAN, which has higher priority than auto voice VLAN that was learned from external sources.
STEP 3 Click Apply. The VLAN properties are written to the Running Configuration file.

Displaying Auto Voice VLAN Settings


If Auto Voice VLAN mode is enabled, use the Auto Voice VLAN page to view the relevant global and interface parameters. You can also use this page to manually restart Auto Voice VLAN, by clicking Restart Auto Voice VLAN. After a short delay, this resets the voice VLAN to the default voice VLAN and restarts the Auto Voice VLAN discovery and synchronization process on all the switches in the LAN that are Auto Voice VLAN enabled.
NOTE This only resets the voice VLAN to the default voice vlan if the Source Type is in the

Inactive state.
To view Auto Voice VLAN parameters:
STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Voice VLAN > Auto Voice VLAN. The Auto Voice

VLAN page appears. The Operation Status block on this page shows the information about the current voice VLAN and its source: Auto Voice VLAN StatusDisplays whether Auto Voice VLAN is enabled. Voice VLAN IDThe identifier of the current voice VLAN Source TypeDisplays the type of source where the voice VLAN is discovered by the root switch. CoS/802.1pDisplays CoS/802.1p values to be used by the LLDP-MED as a voice network policy. DSCPDisplays DSCP values to be used by the LLDP-MED as a voice network policy.

177

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

12
Root Switch MAC AddressThe MAC address of the Auto Voice VLAN root device that discovers or is configured with the voice VLAN from which the voice VLAN is learned. Switch MAC AddressBase MAC address of the switch. If the device's Switch MAC address is the Root Switch MAC Address, the device is the Auto Voice VLAN root device. Voice VLAN ID Change TimeLast time that voice VLAN was updated.

STEP 2 Click Restart Auto Voice VLAN to reset the voice VLAN to the default voice VLAN

and restart Auto Voice VLAN discovery on all the Auto-Voice-VLAN-enabled switches in the LAN. The Voice VLAN Local Table displays voice VLAN configured on the switch, as well as any voice VLAN configuration advertised by directly-connected neighbor devices. It contains the following fields: InterfaceDisplays the interface on which voice VLAN configuration was received or configured. If N/A appears, the configuration was done on the switch itself. If an interface appears, a voice configuration was received from a neighbor. Source MAC Address MAC address of a UC from which the voice configuration was received. Source Type Type of UC from which voice configuration was received. The following options are available: DefaultDefault voice VLAN configuration on the switch StaticUser-defined voice VLAN configuration defined on the switch. CDPUC that advertised voice VLAN configuration is running CDP. LLDPUC that advertised voice VLAN configuration is running LLDP. Voice VLAN IDThe identifier of the advertised or configured voice VLAN

Voice VLAN IDThe identifier of the current voice VLAN. CoS/802.1pThe advertised or configured CoS/802.1p values that are used by the LLDP-MED as a voice network policy. DSCPThe advertised or configured DSCP values that are used by the LLDP-MED as a voice network policy.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

178

12
-

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

Best Local SourceDisplays whether this voice VLAN was used by the switch. The following options are available: YesThe switch uses this voice VLAN to synchronize with other Auto Voice VLAN-enabled switches. This voice VLAN is the voice VLAN for the network unless a voice VLAN from a higher priority source is discovered. Only one local source is the best local source. NoThis is not the best local source.

STEP 3 Click Refresh to refresh the information on the page

Configuring Telephony OUI


OUIs are assigned by the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Incorporated (IEEE) Registration Authority. Since the number of IP phone manufacturers is limited and well-known, the known OUI values cause the relevant frames, and the port on which they are seen, to be automatically assigned to a Voice VLAN. The OUI Global table can hold up to 128 OUIs. This section covers the following topics: Adding OUIs to the Telephony OUI Table Adding Interfaces to Voice VLAN on Basis of OUIs

Adding OUIs to the Telephony OUI Table


Use the Telephony OUI page to configure Telephony OUI QoS properties. In addition, the Auto Membership Aging time can be configured. If the specified time period passes with no telephony activity, the port is removed from the Voice VLAN. Use the Telephony OUI page to view existing OUIs, and add new OUIs.

179

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

12
To configure Telephony OUI and/or add a new Voice VLAN OUI: page appears. The Telephony OUI page contains the following fields: Telephony OUI Operational StatusDisplays whether OUIs are used to identify voice traffic. CoS/802.1pSelect the CoS queue to be assigned to voice traffic. Remark CoS/802.1pSelect whether to remark egress traffic. Auto Membership Aging TimeEnter the time delay to remove a port from the voice VLAN after all of the MAC addresses of the phones detected on the ports have aged out.

STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Voice VLAN > Telephony OUI. The Telephony OUI

STEP 2 Click Apply to update the Running Configuration of the switch with these values.

The Telephony OUI table appears: Telephony OUIFirst six digits of the MAC address that are reserved for OUIs. DescriptionUser-assigned OUI description.

STEP 3 Click Restore OUI Defaults to delete all of the user-created OUIs, and leave only

the default OUIs in the table. To delete all the OUIs, select the top checkbox. All the OUIs are selected and can be deleted by clicking Delete. If you then click Restore, the system recovers the known OUIs.
STEP 4 To add a new OUI, click Add. The Add Telephony OUI page appears. STEP 5 Enter the values for the following fields:

Telephony OUIEnter a new OUI. DescriptionEnter an OUI name.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The OUI is added to the Telephony OUI Table.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

180

12
Adding Interfaces to Voice VLAN on Basis of OUIs

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

The QoS attributes can be assigned per port to the voice packets in one of the following modes: AllQuality of Service (QoS) values configured to the Voice VLAN are applied to all of the incoming frames that are received on the interface and are classified to the Voice VLAN. Telephony Source MAC Address (SRC)The QoS values configured for the Voice VLAN are applied to any incoming frame that is classified to the Voice VLAN and contains an OUI in the source MAC address that matches a configured telephony OUI.

Use the Telephony OUI Interface page to add an interface to the voice VLAN on the basis of the OUI identifier and to configure the OUI QoS mode of voice VLAN. To configure Telephony OUI on an interface:
STEP 1 Click VLAN Management > Voice VLAN > Telephony OUI Interface. The

Telephony OUI Interface page appears. The Telephony OUI Interface page contains voice VLAN OUI parameters for all interfaces.
STEP 2 To configure an interface to be a candidate port of the telephony OUI-based voice

VLAN, click Edit. The Edit Interface Settings page appears.


STEP 3 Enter the values for the following fields:

InterfaceSelect an interface. Telephony OUI VLAN MembershipIf enabled, the interface is a candidate port of the telephony OUI based voice VLAN. When packets that match one of the configured telephony OUI are received, the port is added to the voice VLAN. Voice VLAN QoS ModeSelect one of the following options: AllQoS attributes are applied on all packets that are classified to the Voice VLAN. Telephony Source MAC AddressQoS attributes are applied only on packets from IP phones.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The OUI is added.

181

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

VLAN Management
Voice VLAN

12

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

182

13
Spanning Tree
This section describes the Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) (IEEE802.1D and IEEE802.1Q) and covers the following topics: STP Flavors Configuring STP Status and Global Settings Defining Spanning Tree Interface Settings Configuring Rapid Spanning Tree Settings

STP Flavors
STP protects a Layer 2 Broadcast domain from Broadcast storms by selectively setting links to standby mode to prevent loops. In standby mode, these links temporarily stop transferring user data. After the topology changes so that the data transfer is made possible, the links are automatically re-activated. Loops occur when alternate routes exist between hosts. Loops in an extended network can cause switches to forward traffic indefinitely, resulting in increased traffic load and reduced network efficiency. STP provides a tree topology for any arrangement of switches and interconnecting links, by creating a unique path between end stations on a network, and thereby eliminating loops. The switch supports the following Spanning Tree Protocol versions: Classic STP Provides a single path between any two end stations, avoiding and eliminating loops. Rapid STP (RSTP) Detects network topologies to provide faster convergence of the spanning tree. This is most effective when the network

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

183

Spanning Tree
Configuring STP Status and Global Settings

13

topology is naturally tree-structured, and therefore faster convergence might be possible. RSTP is enabled by default.
NOTE The 200 series switches do not support MSTP.

Configuring STP Status and Global Settings


The STP Status and Global Settings page contains parameters for enabling STP or RSTP. Use the STP Interface Settings page and RSTP Interface Settings page to configure ports with these modes, respectively. To set the STP status and global settings:
STEP 1 Click Spanning Tree > STP Status & Global Settings. The STP Status & Global

Settings page appears.


STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

Global Settings: Spanning Tree StateEnable or disable STP on the switch. STP Operation ModeSelect an STP mode. BPDU HandlingSelect how Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) packets are managed when STP is disabled on the port or the switch. BPDUs are used to transmit spanning tree information. FilteringFilters BPDU packets when Spanning Tree is disabled on an interface. FloodingFloods BPDU packets when Spanning Tree is disabled on an interface.

Path Cost Default ValuesSelects the method used to assign default path costs to the STP ports. The default path cost assigned to an interface varies according to the selected method. ShortSpecifies the range 1 through 65,535 for port path costs. LongSpecifies the range 1 through 200,000,000 for port path costs.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

184

13
Bridge Settings:

Spanning Tree
Configuring STP Status and Global Settings

PrioritySets the bridge priority value. After exchanging BPDUs, the device with the lowest priority becomes the Root Bridge. In the case that all bridges use the same priority, then their MAC addresses are used to determine the Root Bridge. The bridge priority value is provided in increments of 4096. For example, 4096, 8192, 12288, and so on. Hello TimeSet the interval (in seconds) that a Root Bridge waits between configuration messages. Max AgeSet the interval (in seconds) that the switch can wait without receiving a configuration message, before attempting to redefine its own configuration. Forward DelaySet the interval (in seconds) that a bridge remains in a learning state before forwarding packets. For more information, refer to Defining Spanning Tree Interface Settings.

Designated Root: Bridge IDThe bridge priority concatenated with the MAC address of the switch. Root Bridge ID The Root Bridge priority concatenated with the MAC address of the Root Bridge. Root PortThe port that offers the lowest cost path from this bridge to the Root Bridge. (This is significant when the bridge is not the root.) Root Path CostThe cost of the path from this bridge to the root. Topology Changes CountsThe total number of STP topology changes that have occurred. Last Topology ChangeThe time interval that elapsed since the last topology change occurred. The time appears in a days/hours/minutes/ seconds format.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The STP Global settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

185

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Spanning Tree
Defining Spanning Tree Interface Settings

13

Defining Spanning Tree Interface Settings


The STP Interface Settings page enables you to configure STP on a per-port basis, and to view the information learned by the protocol, such as the designated bridge. The defined configuration entered is valid for all flavors of the STP protocol. To configure STP on an interface:
STEP 1 Click Spanning Tree > STP Interface Settings. The STP Interface Settings page

appears.
STEP 2 Select an interface and click Edit. The Edit Interface Settings page appears. STEP 3 Enter the parameters

InterfaceSelect the Port or LAG on which Spanning Tree is configured. STPEnables or disables STP on the port. Edge PortEnables or disables Fast Link on the port. If Fast Link mode is enabled on a port, the port is automatically set to Forwarding state when the port link is up. Fast Link optimizes the STP protocol convergence. The options are: EnableEnables Fast Link immediately. AutoEnables Fast Link a few seconds after the interface becomes active. This allows STP to resolve loops before enabling Fast Link. DisableDisables Fast Link.
NOTE It is recommended to set the value to Auto so that the switch sets

the port to fast link mode if a host is connected to it, or sets it as a regular STP port if connected to another switch. This helps avoid loops. BPDU HandlingSelect how BPDU packets are managed when STP is disabled on the port or the switch. BPDUs are used to transmit spanning tree information. Use Global SettingsSelect to use the settings defined in the STP Status and Global Settings page. FilteringFilters BPDU packets when Spanning Tree is disabled on an interface.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

186

13

Spanning Tree
Defining Spanning Tree Interface Settings

FloodingFloods BPDU packets when Spanning Tree is disabled on an interface.

Path CostSet the port contribution to the root path cost or use the default cost generated by the system. PrioritySet the priority value of the port. The priority value influences the port choice when a bridge has two ports connected in a loop. The priority is a value from 0 to 240, set in increments of 16. Port StateDisplays the current STP state of a port. DisabledSTP is currently disabled on the port. The port forwards traffic while learning MAC addresses. BlockingThe port is currently blocked, and cannot forward traffic (with the exception of BPDU data) or learn MAC addresses. ListeningThe port is in Listening mode. The port cannot forward traffic, and cannot learn MAC addresses. LearningThe port is in Learning mode. The port cannot forward traffic, but it can learn new MAC addresses. ForwardingThe port is in Forwarding mode. The port can forward traffic and learn new MAC addresses.

Designated Bridge IDDisplays the bridge priority and the MAC address of the designated bridge. Designated Port IDDisplays the priority and interface of the selected port. Designated CostDisplays the cost of the port participating in the STP topology. Ports with a lower cost are less likely to be blocked if STP detects loops. Forward TransitionsDisplays the number of times the port has changed from the Blocking state to Forwarding state. SpeedDisplays the speed of the port. LAGDisplays the LAG to which the port belongs. If a port is a member of a LAG, the LAG settings override the port settings.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The interface settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

187

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Spanning Tree
Configuring Rapid Spanning Tree Settings

13

Configuring Rapid Spanning Tree Settings


Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP) enables a faster STP convergence without creating forwarding loops. The RSTP Interface Settings page enables you to configure RSTP per port. Any configuration that is done on this page is active when the global STP mode is set to RSTP . To enter RSTP settings:
STEP 1 Click Spanning Tree > STP Status and Global Settings. The STP Status and

Global Settings page appears. Enable RSTP.


STEP 2 Click Spanning Tree > RSTP Interface Settings. The RSTP Interface Settings

page appears:
STEP 3 Select a port. NOTE Activate Protocol Migration is only available after selecting the port

that is connected to the bridge partner being tested.


STEP 4 If a link partner is discovered by using STP, click Activate Protocol Migration to

run a Protocol Migration test. This discovers whether the link partner using STP still exists, and if so whether it has migrated to RSTP. If it still exists as an STP link, the device continues to communicate with it by using STP. Otherwise, if it has been migrated to RSTP, the device communicates with it using RSTP.
STEP 5 Select an interface, and click Edit. The Edit RSTP Interface setting page appears. STEP 6 Enter the parameters

InterfaceSet the interface, and specify the port or LAG where RSTP is to be configured. Point to Point Administrative StatusDefine the point-to-point link status. Ports defined as Full Duplex are considered Point-to-Point port links. -

EnableThis port is an RSTP edge port when this feature is enabled, and
is brought to Forwarding mode quickly (usually within 2 seconds).

DisableThe port is not considered point-to-point for RSTP purposes,


which means that STP works on it at regular speed, as opposed to high speed.

AutoAutomatically determines the switch status by using RSTP


BPDUs.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

188

13

Spanning Tree
Configuring Rapid Spanning Tree Settings

Point to Point Operational StatusDisplays the Point-to-Point operational status if the Point to Point Administrative Status is set to Auto. RoleDisplays the role of the port that was assigned by STP to provide STP paths. The possible roles are: -

RootLowest cost path to forward packets to the Root Bridge. DesignatedThe interface through which the bridge is connected to the
LAN, which provides the lowest cost path from the LAN to the Root Bridge.

AlternateProvides an alternate path to the Root Bridge from the root


interface.

BackupProvides a backup path to the designated port path toward the


Spanning Tree leaves. This provides a configuration in which two ports are connected in a loop by a point-to-point link. Backup ports are also used when a LAN has two or more established connections to a shared segment.

DisabledThe port is not participating in Spanning Tree.

ModeDisplays the current Spanning Tree mode: Classic STP or RSTP. Fast Link Operational StatusDisplays whether the Fast Link (Edge Port) is enabled, disabled, or automatic for the interface. The values are: -

EnabledFast Link is enabled. DisabledFast Link is disabled. AutoFast Link mode is enabled a few seconds after the interface becomes active.

Port StatusDisplays the RSTP status on the specific port. -

DisabledSTP is currently disabled on the port. BlockingThe port is currently blocked, and it cannot forward traffic or
learn MAC addresses.

ListeningThe port is in Listening mode. The port cannot forward traffic,


and cannot learn MAC addresses.

LearningThe port is in Learning mode. The port cannot forward traffic,


however it can learn new MAC addresses.

ForwardingThe port is in Forwarding mode. The port can forward


traffic and learn new MAC addresses.

189

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Spanning Tree
Configuring Rapid Spanning Tree Settings

13

STEP 7 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

190

14
Managing MAC Address Tables
This section describe how to add MAC addresses to the system. It covers the following topics: Configuring Static MAC Addresses Managing Dynamic MAC Addresses

Types of MAC Addresses


There are two types of MAC addressesstatic and dynamic. Depending on their type, MAC addresses are either stored in the Static Address table or in the Dynamic Address table, along with VLAN and port information. Static addresses are configured by the user, and therefore, they do not expire. A new source MAC address that appears in a frame arriving at the switch is added to the Dynamic Address table. This MAC address is retained for a configurable period of time. If another frame with the same source MAC address does not arrive at the switch before that time period expires, the MAC entry is aged (deleted) from the table. When a frame arrives at the switch, the switch searches for a corresponding/ matching destination MAC address entry in the static or dynamic table. If a match is found, the frame is marked for egress on a the port specified in the table. If frames are sent to a MAC address that is not found in the tables, they are transmitted/broadcasted to all the ports on the relevant VLAN. Such frames are referred to as unknown Unicast frames. The switch supports a maximum of 8K static and dynamic MAC addresses.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

191

Managing MAC Address Tables


Configuring Static MAC Addresses

14

Configuring Static MAC Addresses


Static MAC addresses are assigned to a specific physical interface and VLAN on the switch. If that address is detected on another interface, it is ignored, and is not written to the address table. To define a static address:
STEP 1 Click MAC Address Tables > Static Addresses. The Static Addresses page

appears. The Static Addresses page contains the defined static addresses.
STEP 2 Click Add. The Add Static Address page appears. STEP 3 Enter the parameters.

VLAN IDSelect the VLAN ID for the port. MAC AddressEnter the interface MAC address. InterfaceSelect an interface (port, or LAG) for the entry. StatusSelect how the entry is treated. The options are: PermanentThe system never removes this MAC address. If the static MAC address is saved in the Startup Configuration, it is retained after rebooting. Delete on resetThe static MAC address is deleted when the device is reset. Delete on timeoutThe MAC address is deleted when aging occurs. SecureThe MAC address is secure when the interface is in classic locked mode (see Configuring Port Security).

STEP 4 Click Apply. A new entry appears in the table.

Managing Dynamic MAC Addresses


The Dynamic Address Table (bridging table) contains the MAC addresses acquired by monitoring the source addresses of frames entering the switch.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

192

14

Managing MAC Address Tables


Managing Dynamic MAC Addresses

To prevent this table from overflowing and to make room for new MAC addresses, an address is deleted if no corresponding traffic is received for a certain period. This period of time is the aging interval.

Configuring Dynamic MAC Address Aging Time


To configure the aging interval for dynamic addresses:
STEP 1 Click MAC Address Tables > Dynamic Address Settings. The Dynamic Address

Settings page appears.


STEP 2 Enter Aging Time. The aging time is a value between the user-configured value

and twice that value minus 1. For example, if you entered 300 seconds, the aging time is between 300 and 599 seconds.
STEP 3 Click Apply. The aging time is updated.

Querying Dynamic Addresses


To query dynamic addresses:
STEP 1 Click MAC Address Tables > Dynamic Addresses. The Dynamic Addresses page

appears.
STEP 2 In the Filter block, you can enter the following query criteria:

VLAN IDEnter the VLAN ID for which the table is queried. MAC AddressEnter the MAC address for which the table is queried. InterfaceSelect the interface for which the table is queried. The query can search for specific unit/slot, ports, or LAGs.

STEP 3 Enter the Dynamic Address Table Sort Key field by which the table is sorted. The

address table can be sorted by VLAN ID, MAC address, or interface.


STEP 4 Click Go. The Dynamic MAC Address Table is queried and the results are

displayed. To delete all of the dynamic MAC addresses. click Clear Table.

193

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Managing MAC Address Tables


Managing Dynamic MAC Addresses

14

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

194

15
Multicast
This section describes the Multicast Forwarding feature, and covers the following topics: Multicast Forwarding Defining Multicast Properties Adding MAC Group Address Adding IP Multicast Group Addresses Configuring IGMP Snooping MLD Snooping Querying IGMP/MLD IP Multicast Group Defining Multicast Router Ports Defining Forward All Multicast Defining Unregistered Multicast Settings

Multicast Forwarding
Multicast forwarding enables one-to-many information dissemination. Multicast applications are useful for dissemination of information to multiple clients, where clients do not require reception of the entire content. A typical application is a cable-TV-like service, where clients can join a channel in the middle of a transmission, and leave before it ends. The data is sent only to relevant ports. Forwarding the data only to the relevant ports conserves bandwidth and host resources on links.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

195

Multicast
Multicast Forwarding

15
For Multicast forwarding to work across IP subnets, nodes, and routers must be Multicast-capable. A Multicast-capable node must be able to: Send and receive Multicast packets. Register the Multicast addresses being listened to by the node with local routers, so that local and remote routers can route the Multicast packet to the nodes.

Typical Multicast Setup


While Multicast routers route Multicast packets between IP subnets, Multicastcapable Layer 2 switches forward Multicast packets to registered nodes within a LAN or VLAN. A typical setup involves a router that forwards the Multicast streams between private and/or public IP networks, a switch with Internet Group Membership Protocol (IGMP) snooping capabilities, or Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping, and a Multicast client that wants to receive a Multicast stream. In this setup, the router sends IGMP queries periodically.
NOTE MLD for IPv6 is derived from the IGMP v2 for IPv4. Even though the description in

this section is mostly for IGMP, it also describes coverage of MLD where implied. These queries reach the switch, which in turn floods the queries to the VLAN, and also learns the port where there is a Multicast router (Mrouter). When a host receives the IGMP query message, it responds with an IGMP Join message saying that the host wants to receive a specific Multicast stream and optionally from a specific source. The switch with the IGMP snooping analyzes the Join messages, and learns that the Multicast stream the host has requested must be forwarded to this specific port. It then forwards the IGMP Join to the Mrouter only. Similarly, when the Mrouter receives an IGMP Join message, it learns the interface from which it received the Join messages that wants to receive a specific Multicast stream. The Mrouter forwards the requested Multicast stream to the interface.

Multicast Operation
In a Layer 2 Multicast service, a Layer 2 switch receives a single frame addressed to a specific Multicast address. It creates copies of the frame to be transmitted on each relevant port. When the switch is IGMP/MLD-snooping-enabled and receives a frame for a Multicast stream, it forwards the Multicast frame to all the ports that have registered to receive the Multicast stream using IGMP Join messages.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

196

15
Multicast MAC Group Address IP Multicast Group Address (G)

Multicast
Multicast Forwarding

The switch can forward Multicast streams based on one of the following options:

A combination of the source IP address (S) and the destination IP Multicast Group Address (G) of the Multicast packet.

One of these options can be configured per VLAN. The system maintains lists of Multicast groups for each VLAN, and this manages the Multicast information that each port should receive. The Multicast groups and their receiving ports can be configured statically or learned dynamically using IGMP or Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) protocols snooping.

Multicast Registration
Multicast registration is the process of listening and responding to Multicast registration protocols. The available protocols are IGMP for IPv4 and MLD for IPv6. When IGMP/MLD snooping is enabled in a switch on a VLAN, it analyzes the IGMP/ MLD packets it receives from the VLAN connected to the switch and Multicast routers in the network. When a switch learns that a host is using IGMP/MLD messages to register to receive a Multicast stream, optionally from a specific source, the switch adds the registration to its Multicast Forwarding Data Base (MFDB). IGMP/MLD snooping can effectively reduce Multicast traffic from streaming bandwidth-intensive IP applications. A switch using IGMP/MLD snooping only forwards Multicast traffic to the hosts interested in that traffic. This reduction of Multicast traffic reduces the packet processing at the switch, and also reduces the workload of the end hosts, since they do not have to receive and filter all of the Multicast traffic generated in the network.

197

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Multicast
Defining Multicast Properties

15
IGMP v1/v2/ v3 MLD v1/v2

The following versions are supported:

Multicast Address Properties


Multicast addresses have the following properties: Each IPv4 Multicast address is in the address range 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255. The IPv6 Multicast address is FF00:/8. To map an IP Multicast group address to an Layer 2 Multicast address: For IPv4, this is mapped by taking the 23 low-order bits from the IPv4 address, and adding them to the 01:00:5e prefix. By standard, the upper nine bits of the IP address are ignored, and any IP addresses that only differ in the value of these upper bits are mapped to the same Layer 2 address, since the lower 23 bits that are used are identical. For example, 234.129.2.3 is mapped to a MAC Multicast group address 01:00:5e:01:02:03. Up to 32 IP Multicast group addresses can be mapped to the same Layer 2 address. For IPv6, this is mapped by taking the 32 low-order bits of the Multicast address, and adding the prefix of 33:33. For example, the IPv6 Multicast address FF00:1122:3344 is mapped to Layer 2 Multicast 33:33:11:22:33:44.

Defining Multicast Properties


The Properties page enables you to configure the Bridge Multicast filtering status. By default, all Multicast frames are flooded to all ports of the VLAN. To selectively forward only to relevant ports and filter (drop) the Multicast on the rest of the ports, enable Bridge Multicast filtering status in the Properties page. If filtering is enabled, Multicast frames are forwarded to a subset of the ports in the relevant VLAN as defined in the Multicast Forwarding Data Base. Multicast filtering is enforced on all traffic. By default, such traffic is flooded to all relevant ports, but you can limit forwarding to a smaller subset.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

198

15

Multicast
Defining Multicast Properties

A common way of representing Multicast membership is the (S,G) notation where S is the (single) source sending a Multicast stream of data, and G is the IPv4 or IPv6 group address. If a Multicast client can receive Multicast traffic from any source of a specific Multicast group, this is written as (*,G). The following are ways of forwarding Multicast frames: MAC Group AddressBased on the destination MAC address in the Ethernet frame.
NOTE As mentioned before, one or more IP Multicast group addresses can be mapped to a MAC group address. Forwarding, based on the MAC group address, can result in an IP Multicast stream being forwarded to ports that have no receiver for the stream.

IP Group AddressBased on the destination IP address of the IP packet (*,G). Source Specific IP Group AddressBased on both the destination IP address and the source IP address of the IP packet (S,G).

By selecting the forwarding mode, you can define the method used by hardware to identify Multicast flow by one of the following options: MAC Group Address, IP Group Address, or Source Specific IP Group Address. (S,G) is supported by IGMPv3 and MLDv2, while IGMPv1/2 and MLDv1 support only (*.G), which is just the group ID. The switch supports a maximum of 256 static and dynamic Multicast group addresses. To enable Multicast filtering, and select the forwarding method:
STEP 1 Click Multicast> Properties. The Properties page appears. STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

Bridge Multicast Filtering StatusSelect to enable filtering. VLAN IDSelect the VLAN ID to set its forwarding method. Forwarding Method for IPv6Set one of the following forwarding methods for IPv6 addresses: MAC Group Address, IP Group Address, or Source Specific IP Group Address. Forwarding Method for IPv4Set one of the following forwarding methods for IPv4 addresses: MAC Group Address, IP Group Address, or Source Specific IP Group Address.

199

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Multicast
Adding MAC Group Address

15

STEP 3 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

Adding MAC Group Address


The switch supports forwarding incoming Multicast traffic based on the Multicast group information. This information is derived from the IGMP/MLD packets received or as the result of manual configuration, and it is stored in the Multicast Forwarding Database (MFDB). When a frame is received from a VLAN that is configured to forward Multicast streams, based on MAC group addresses, and its destination address is a Layer 2 Multicast address, the frame is forwarded to all ports that are members of the MAC group address. The MAC Group Address page has the following functions: Query and view information from the MFDB, relating to a specific VLAN ID or a specific MAC address group. This data is acquired either dynamically through IGMP/MLD snooping or statically by manual entry. Add or delete static entries to the MFDB that provide static forwarding information, based on MAC destination addresses. Display a list of all ports/LAGs that are a member of each VLAN ID and MAC address group, and enter whether traffic is forwarded to it or not.

For viewing the forwarding information when the mode is IP Address Group or IP and Source Group, use the IP Multicast Group Address page. To define and view MAC Multicast groups:
STEP 1 Click Multicast > MAC Group Address. The MAC Group Address page appears. STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

VLAN ID Equals ToSet the VLAN ID of the group to be displayed. MAC Group Address Equals ToSet the MAC address of the Multicast group to be displayed. If no MAC Group Address is specified, the page contains all the MAC Group Addresses from the selected VLAN.

STEP 3 Click Go, and the MAC Multicast group addresses are displayed in the lower

block.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

200

15

Multicast
Adding MAC Group Address

Entries that were created both in this page and in the IP Multicast Group Address page are displayed. For those created in the IP Multicast Group Address page, the IP addresses are converted to MAC addresses.
STEP 4 Click Add to add a static MAC Group Address. The Add MAC Group Address

page appears.
STEP 5 Enter the parameters.

VLAN IDDefines the VLAN ID of the new Multicast group. MAC Group AddressDefines the MAC address of the new Multicast group.

STEP 6 Click Apply, the MAC Multicast group is written to the Running Configuration file.

To configure and display the registration for the interfaces within the group, select an address, and click Details. The MAC Group Address Settings page appears. The page contains: VLAN IDThe VLAN ID of the Multicast group. MAC Group AddressThe MAC address of the group.

STEP 7 Select the port or LAG to be displayed from the Filter: Interface Type menu. STEP 8 Click Go to display the port or LAG membership. STEP 9 Select the way that each interface is associated with the Multicast group:

StaticAttaches the interface to the Multicast group as a static member. DynamicIndicates that the interface was added to the Multicast group as a result of IGMP/MLD snooping. ForbiddenSpecifies that this port is not allowed to join this group on this VLAN. NoneSpecifies that the port is not currently a member of this Multicast group on this VLAN.

STEP 10 Click Apply, and the Running Configuration file is updated. NOTE Entries that were created in the IP Multicast Group Address page

cannot be deleted in this page (even if they are selected).

201

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Multicast
Adding IP Multicast Group Addresses

15

Adding IP Multicast Group Addresses


The IP Multicast Group Address page is similar to the MAC Group Address page except that Multicast groups are identified by IP addresses. The IP Multicast Group Address page enables querying and adding IP Multicast groups. To define and view IP Multicast groups:
STEP 1 Click Multicast> IP Multicast Group Address. The IP Multicast Group Address

page appears. The page contains all of the IP Multicast group addresses learned by snooping.
STEP 2 Enter the parameters required for filtering.

VLAN ID equals toDefine the VLAN ID of the group to be displayed. IP Version equals toSelect IPv6 or IPv4. IP Multicast Group Address equals toDefine the IP address of the Multicast group to be displayed. This is only relevant when the Forwarding mode is (S,G). Source IP Address equals toDefine the source IP address of the sending device. If mode is (S,G), enter the sender S. This together with the IP Group Address is the Multicast group ID (S,G) to be displayed. If mode is (*.G), enter an * to indicate that the Multicast group is only defined by destination.

STEP 3 Click Go. The results are displayed in the lower block. The IP Multicast address of

Bonjour appears.
STEP 4 Click Add to add a static IP Multicast Group Address. The Add IP Multicast Group

Address page appears.


STEP 5 Enter the parameters.

VLAN IDDefines the VLAN ID of the group to be added. IP VersionSelect the IP address type. IP Multicast Group AddressDefine the IP address of the new Multicast group. Source SpecificIndicates that the entry contains a specific source, and adds the address in the IP Source Address field. If not, the entry is added as a (*,G) entry, an IP group address from any IP source.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

202

15

Multicast
Configuring IGMP Snooping

IP Source AddressDefines the source address to be included.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The IP Multicast group is added, and the device is updated. STEP 7 To configure and display the registration of an IP group address, select an address

and click Details. The IP Multicast Interface Settings page appears. The VLAN ID, IP Version, IP Multicast Group Address, and Source IP Address selected are displayed as read-only in the top of the window. You can select the filter type: Interface Type equals toSelect whether to display ports or LAGs.

STEP 8 For each interface, select its association type. The options are as follows:

StaticAttaches the interface to the Multicast group as a static member. ForbiddenSpecifies that this port is forbidden from joining this group on this VLAN. NoneIndicates that the port is not currently a member of this Multicast group on this VLAN. This is selected by default until Static or Forbidden is selected.

STEP 9 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

Configuring IGMP Snooping


To support selective Multicast forwarding (IPv4), Bridge Multicast filtering must be enabled (in the Properties page), and IGMP Snooping must be enabled globally and for each relevant VLAN (in the IGMP Snooping page). By default, a Layer 2 switch forwards Multicast frames to all ports of the relevant VLAN, essentially treating the frame as if it were a Broadcast. With IGMP Snooping the switch forwards Multicast frames to ports that have registered Multicast clients.
NOTE The switch supports IGMP Snooping only on static VLANs. It does not support

IGMP Snooping on dynamic VLANs.

203

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Multicast
Configuring IGMP Snooping

15
When IGMP Snooping is enabled globally or on a VLAN, all IGMP packets are forwarded to the CPU. The CPU analyzes the incoming packets, and determines the following: Which ports are asking to join which Multicast groups on what VLAN. Which ports are connected to Multicast routers (Mrouters) that are generating IGMP queries. Which ports are receiving PIM, DVMRP, or IGMP query protocols.

These are displayed on the IGMP Snooping page. Ports, asking to join a specific Multicast group, issue an IGMP report that specifies which group(s) the host wants to join. This results in the creation of a forwarding entry in the Multicast Forwarding Data Base. To enable IGMP Snooping and identify the switch as an IGMP Snooping Querier on a VLAN:
STEP 1 Click Multicast > IGMP Snooping. The IGMP Snooping page appears. STEP 2 Enable or disable the IGMP Snooping status.

When IGMP Snooping is enabled globally, the device monitoring network traffic can determine which hosts have requested to receive Multicast traffic. The switch only performs IGMP Snooping if both IGMP snooping and Bridge Multicast filtering are enabled.
STEP 3 Select a VLAN, and click Edit . The Edit IGMP Snooping page appears. STEP 4 Enter the parameters.

VLAN IDSelect the VLAN ID on which IGMP snooping is defined. IGMP Snooping StatusEnable or disable the monitoring of network traffic for the selected VLAN. Operational IGMP Snooping StatusDisplays the current status of the IGMP Snooping for the selected VLAN. MRouter Ports Auto LearnEnable or disable auto learning of the ports to which the Mrouter is connected. Query RobustnessEnter the Robustness Variable value to be used if this switch is the elected querier.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

204

15

Multicast
MLD Snooping

Operational Query RobustnessDisplays the robustness variable sent by the elected querier. Query IntervalEnter the interval between the General Queries to be used if this switch is the elected querier. Operational Query IntervalThe time interval in seconds between General Queries sent by the elected querier. Query Max Response IntervalEnter the delay used to calculate the Maximum Response Code inserted into the periodic General Queries. Operational Query Max Response IntervalDisplays the Query Max Response Interval included in the General Queries sent by the elected querier. Last Member Query CounterEnter the number of IGMP Group-Specific Queries sent before the switch assumes there are no more members for the group, if the switch is the elected querier. Operational Last Member Query CounterDisplays the operational value of the Last Member Query Counter. Last Member Query IntervalEnter the Maximum Response Delay to be used if the switch cannot read Max Response Time value from groupspecific queries sent by the elected querier. Operational Last Member Query IntervalDisplays the Last Member Query Interval sent by the elected querier. Immediate LeaveEnable Immediate Leave to decrease the time it takes to block a Multicast stream sent to a member port when an IGMP Group Leave message is received on that port.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

MLD Snooping
Hosts use the MLD protocol to report their participation in Multicast sessions, and the switch uses MLD snooping to build Multicast membership lists. It uses these lists to forward Multicast packets only to switch ports where there are host nodes that are members of the Multicast groups. The switch does not support MLD Querier.

205

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Multicast
MLD Snooping

15
Hosts use the MLD protocol to report their participation in Multicast sessions. The switch supports two versions of MLD snooping: MLDv1 snooping detects MLDv1 control packets, and sets up traffic bridging, based on IPv6 destination Multicast addresses. MLDv2 snooping uses MLDv2 control packets to forward traffic based on the source IPv6 address, and the destination IPv6 Multicast address.

The actual MLD version is selected by the Multicast router in the network. In an approach similar to IGMP snooping, MLD frames are snooped as they are forwarded by the switch from stations to an upstream Multicast router and vice versa. This facility enables a switch to conclude the following: On which ports stations interested in joining a specific Multicast group are located On which ports Multicast routers sending Multicast frames are located

This knowledge is used to exclude irrelevant ports (ports on which no stations have registered to receive a specific Multicast group) from the forwarding set of an incoming Multicast frame. If you enable MLD snooping in addition to the manually-configured Multicast groups, the result is a union of the Multicast groups and port memberships derived from the manual setup and the dynamic discovery by MLD snooping. Only static definitions are preserved when the system is rebooted. To enable MLD Snooping:
STEP 1 Click Multicast > MLD Snooping. The MLD Snooping page appears. STEP 2 Enable or disable MLD Snooping Status. When MLD Snooping is globally

enabled, the device monitoring network traffic can determine which hosts have requested to receive Multicast traffic. The switch performs MLD Snooping only if both MLD snooping and Bridge Multicast filtering are enabled.
STEP 3 Select a VLAN, and click Edit . The Edit MLD Snooping page appears. STEP 4 Enter the parameters.

VLAN IDSelect the VLAN ID. MLD Snooping StatusEnable or disable MLD snooping on the VLAN. The switch monitors network traffic to determine which hosts have asked to be sent Multicast traffic. The switch performs MLD snooping only when MLD snooping and Bridge Multicast filtering are both enabled
206

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

15

Multicast
MLD Snooping

Operational MLD Snooping StatusDisplays the current status of MLD Snooping for the selected VLAN. MRouter Ports Auto-LearnEnable or disable Auto Learn for the Multicast router. Query RobustnessEnter the Robustness Variable value to be used if the switch cannot read this value from messages sent by the elected querier. Operational Query RobustnessDisplays the robustness variable sent by the elected querier. Query IntervalEnter the Query Interval value to be used by the switch if the switch cannot derive the value from the messages sent by the elected querier. Operational Query IntervalThe time interval in seconds between General Queries received from the elected querier. Query Max Response IntervalEnter Query Max Response delay to be used if the switch cannot read the Max Response Time value from General Queries sent by the elected querier. Operational Query Max Response IntervalDisplays the delay used to calculate the Maximum Response Code inserted into the General Queries. Last Member Query CounterEnter the Last Member Query Count to be used if the switch cannot derive the value from the messages sent by the elected querier. Operational Last Member Query CounterDisplays the operational value of the Last Member Query Counter. Last Member Query IntervalEnter the Maximum Response Delay to be used if the switch cannot read Max Response Time value from GroupSpecific queries sent by the elected querier. Operational Last Member Query IntervalThe Last Member Query Interval sent by the elected querier. Immediate LeaveWhen enabled, reduces the time it takes to block unnecessary MLD traffic sent to a switch port.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

207

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Multicast
Querying IGMP/MLD IP Multicast Group

15

Querying IGMP/MLD IP Multicast Group


The IGMP/MLD IP Multicast Group page displays the IPv4 and IPv6 group address learned from IGMP/MLD messages. There might be a difference between information on this page and, for example, information displayed in the MAC Group Address page. Assuming that the system is in MAC-based groups and a port that requested to join the following Multicast groups 224.1.1.1 and 225.1.1.1, both are mapped to the same MAC Multicast address 01:00:5e:01:01:01. In this case, there is a single entry in the MAC Multicast page, but two entries on this page. To query for a IP Multicast group:
STEP 1 Click Multicast > IGMP/MLD IP Multicast Group. The IGMP/MLD IP Multicast

Group page appears.


STEP 2 Set the type of snooping group for which to search: IGMP or MLD. STEP 3 Enter some or all of following query filter criteria:

Group Address equals toDefines the Multicast group MAC address or IP address to query. Source Address equals toDefines the sender address to query. VLAN ID equals toDefines the VLAN ID to query.

STEP 4 Click Go. The following fields are displayed for each Multicast group:

VLANThe VLAN ID. Group AddressThe Multicast group MAC address or IP address. Source AddressThe sender address for all of the specified group ports. Included PortsThe list of destination ports for the Multicast stream. Excluded PortsThe list of ports not included in the group. Compatibility ModeThe oldest IGMP/MLD version of registration from the hosts the switch receives on the IP group address.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

208

15
Defining Multicast Router Ports

Multicast
Defining Multicast Router Ports

A Multicast router (Mrouter) port is a port that connects to a Multicast router. The switch includes the Multicast router port(s) numbers when it forwards the Multicast streams and IGMP/MLD registration messages. This is required so that the Multicast routers can, in turn, forward the Multicast streams and propagate the registration messages to other subnets. To statically configure or see dynamically-detected ports connected to the Multicast router:
STEP 1 Click Multicast > Multicast Router Port . The Multicast Router Port page appears. STEP 2 Enter some or all of following query filter criteria:

VLAN ID equals toSelect the VLAN ID for the router ports that are described. IP Version equals toSelect the IP version that the Multicast router supports. Interface Type equals toSelect whether to display ports or LAGs.

STEP 3 Click Go. The interfaces matching the query criteria are displayed. STEP 4 For each port or LAG, select its association type. The options are as follows:

StaticThe port is statically configured as a Multicast router port. Dynamic(Display only) The port is dynamically configured as a Multicast router port by a MLD/IGMP query. To enable the dynamic learning of Multicast router ports, go to the Multicast > IGMP Snooping page, and the Multicast > MLD Snooping page ForbiddenThis port is not to be configured as a Multicast router port, even if IGMP or MLD queries are received on this port. If Forbidden is enabled on a port, Mrouter is not learned on this port (i.e. MRouter Ports Auto-Learn is not enabled on this port). NoneThe port is not currently a Multicast router port.

STEP 5 Click Apply to update the switch.

209

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Multicast
Defining Forward All Multicast

15

Defining Forward All Multicast


The Forward All page enables and displays the configuration of the ports and/or LAGs that are to receive Multicast streams from a specific VLAN. This feature requires that Bridge Multicast filtering in the Properties page be enabled. If it is disabled, then all Multicast traffic is flooded to ports in the switch. You can statically (manually) configure a port to Forward All, if the devices connecting to the port do not support IGMP and/or MLD. IGMP or MLD messages are not forwarded to ports defined as Forward All.
NOTE The configuration affects only the ports that are members of the selected VLAN.

To define Forward All Multicast:


STEP 1 Click Multicast > Forward All. The Forward All page appears. STEP 2 Define the following:

VLAN ID equals toThe VLAN ID the ports/LAGs are to be displayed. Interface Type equals toDefine whether to display ports or LAGs.

STEP 3 Click Go. The status of all ports/LAGs are displayed. STEP 4 Select the port/LAG that is to be defined as Forward All by using the following

methods: StaticThe port receives all Multicast streams. ForbiddenPorts cannot receive any Multicast streams, even if IGMP/MLD snooping designated the port to join a Multicast group. NoneThe port is not currently a Forward All port.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

210

15
Defining Unregistered Multicast Settings

Multicast
Defining Unregistered Multicast Settings

Multicast frames are generally forwarded to all ports in the VLAN. If IGMP/MLD Snooping is enabled, the switch learns about the existence of Multicast groups, and monitors which ports have joined which Multicast group. Multicast groups can also be statically configured. Multicast groups that were either dynamically learned or statically configured, are considered registered. The switch forwards Multicast frames (from a registered Multicast group) only to ports that are registered to that Multicast group. The Unregistered Multicast page enables handling Multicast frames that belong to groups that are not known to the switch (unregistered Multicast groups). Unregistered Multicast frames are usually forwarded to all ports on the VLAN. You can select a port to receive or filter unregistered Multicast streams. The configuration is valid for any VLAN of which it is a member (or will be a member). This feature ensures that the customer receives only the Multicast groups requested and not others that may be transmitted in the network. To define unregistered Multicast settings:
STEP 1 Click Multicast > Unregistered Multicast . The Unregistered Multicast page

appears.
STEP 2 Define the following:

Interface Type equals toThe view as all ports or all LAGs. Port/LAGDisplays the port or LAG ID. Unregistered MulticastDisplays the forwarding status of the selected interface. The possible values are: ForwardingEnables forwarding of unregistered Multicast frames to the selected interface. FilteringEnables filtering (rejecting) of unregistered Multicast frames to the selected interface.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The settings are saved, and the Running Configuration file is updated.

211

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Multicast
Defining Unregistered Multicast Settings

15

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

212

16
IP Configuration
IP interface addresses can be configured manually by the user, or automatically configured by a DHCP server. This section provides information for defining the switch IP addresses either manually or by making the switch a DHCP client. This section covers the following topics: Management and IP Interfaces Configuring ARP Domain Name Systems

Management and IP Interfaces


Layer 2 IP Addressing
The switch has a single IP address in the management VLAN. This IP address and the default gateway can be configured manually, or by DHCP. The static IP address and default gateway are configured on the IPv4 Interface page. The switch uses the default gateway, if configured, to communicate with devices that are not in the same IP subnet as the switch. By default, VLAN 1 is the management VLAN, but this can be modified. The switch can only be reached at the configured IP address through its management VLAN. The factory default setting of the IP address configuration is DHCP. This means that the switch acts as a DHCP client, and sends out a DHCP request during boot up. If the switch receives a DHCP response from the DHCP server with an IP address, it sends Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) packets to confirm that the IP address is unique. If the ARP response shows that the IP address is in use, the switch sends a DHCPDECLINE message to the offering DHCP server, and sends another DHCPDISCOVER packet that restarts the process.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

213

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

16

If the switch does not receive a DHCP response in 60 seconds, it continues to send DHCPDISCOVER queries, and adopts the default IP address: 192.168.1.254/ 24. IP address collisions occur when the same IP address is used in the same IP subnet by more than one device. Address collisions require administrative actions on the DHCP server and/or the devices that collide with the switch. When a VLAN is configured to use dynamic IP addresses, the switch issues DHCP requests until it is assigned an IP address from a DHCP server. The management VLAN can be configured with a static or dynamic IP address. The IP address assignment rules for the switch are as follows: Unless the switch is configured with a static IP address, it issues DHCP queries until a response is received from a DHCP server. If the IP address on the switch is changed, the switch issues gratuitous ARP packets to the corresponding VLAN to check IP address collisions. This rule also applies when the switch reverts to the default IP address. The system status LED changes to solid green when a new unique IP address is received from the DHCP server. If a static IP address has been set, the system status LED also changes to solid green. The LED flashes when the switch is acquiring an IP address and is currently using the factory default IP address 192.168.1.254. The same rules apply when a client must renew the lease, prior to its expiration date through a DHCPREQUEST message. With factory default settings, when no statically-defined or DHCP-acquired IP address is available, the default IP address is used. When the other IP addresses become available, the addresses are automatically used. The default IP address is always on the management VLAN.

Defining an IPv4 Interface


To manage the switch by using the web-based switch configuration utility, the IPv4 switch management IP address must be defined and known. The switch IP address can be manually configured or automatically taken from a DHCP server. To configure the IPv4 switch IP address:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Management Interface > IPv4 Interface. The IPv4

Interface page appears.


STEP 2 Enter values for the following fields:

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

214

16

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

Management VLANSelect the Management VLAN used to access the switch through telnet or the Web GUI. VLAN1 is the default Management VLAN. IP Address TypeSelect one of the following options: -

DynamicDiscover the IP address using DHCP from the management


VLAN.

StaticManually define a static IP address.

NOTE DHCP Option 12 (Host Name option) is supported when the device is

an DHCP client. If DHCP Option 12 is received from a DHCP server, it is saved as the servers host name. DHCP option 12 will not be requested by the switch. The DHCP server must be configured to send option 12 regardless of what is requested in order to make use of this feature. If a static IP address is used, configure the following fields. IP AddressEnter the IP address, and configure one of the following fields: Network MaskSelect and enter the IP address mask. Prefix LengthSelect and enter the length of the IPv4 address prefix.

Administrative Default GatewaySelect User Defined and enter the default gateway IP address, or select None to remove the selected default gateway IP address from the interface. Operational Default GatewayDisplays the current default gateway status.
NOTE If the switch is not configured with a default gateway, it cannot

communicate with other devices that are not in the same IP subnet. If a dynamic IP address is retrieved from the DHCP server, select those of the following fields that are enabled: Renew IP Address NowThe switch dynamic IP address can be renewed any time after it is assigned by a DHCP server. Note that depending on your DHCP server configuration, the switch might receive a new IP address after the renewal that requires setting the web-based switch configuration utility to the new IP address. Auto Configuration via DHCPDisplays status of Auto Configuration feature. You can configure this from Administration > File Management > DHCP Auto Configuration.

215

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

16

STEP 3 Click Apply. The IPv4 interface settings are written to the Running Configuration

file.

Managing IPv6
The Internet Protocol version 6 (IPv6) is a network-layer protocol for packetswitched internetworks. IPv6 was designed to replace IPv4, the predominantly deployed Internet protocol. IPv6 introduces greater flexibility in assigning IP addresses because the address size increases from 32-bit to 128-bit addresses. IPv6 addresses are written as eight groups of four hexadecimal digits, for example FE80:0000:0000:0000:0000:9C00:876A:130B. The abbreviated form, in which a group of zeroes can be left out, and replaced with '::', is also acceptable, for example, ::-FE80::9C00:876A:130B. IPv6 nodes require an intermediary mapping mechanism to communicate with other IPv6 nodes over an IPv4-only network. This mechanism, called a tunnel, enables IPv6-only hosts to reach IPv4 services, and enables isolated IPv6 hosts and networks to reach an IPv6 node over the IPv4 infrastructure. Tunneling uses the ISATAP mechanism. This protocol treats the IPv4 network as a virtual IPv6 local link, with mappings from each IPv4 address to a link local IPv6 address. The switch detects IPv6 frames by the IPv6 Ethertype.

Defining IPv6 Global Configuration


The IPv6 Global Configuration page defines the frequency of the IPv6 ICMP error messages generated by the switch. To define IPv6 global parameters:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Management Interface > IPv6 Global Configuration.

The IPv6 Global Configuration page appears.


STEP 2 Enter values for the following fields:

ICMPv6 Rate Limit IntervalEnter how often the ICMP error messages are generated.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

216

16

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

ICMPv6 Rate Limit Bucket SizeEnter the maximum number of ICMP error messages that can be sent by the switch per interval.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The IPv6 global parameters are written to the Running Configuration

file.

Defining an IPv6 Interface


An IPv6 interface can be configured on a port, a LAG, VLAN, or ISATAP tunnel interface. The switch supports one IPv6 interface as an IPv6 end device. A tunnel interface is configured with an IPv6 address based on the settings defined in the IPv6 Tunnel page. To define an IPv6 interface:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Management Interface > IPv6 Interface.

The IPv6 Interface page appears. This page contains the IPv6 interfaces already configured.
STEP 2 Click Add to add a new interface on which interface IPv6 is enabled. STEP 3 The Add IPv6 Interface page appears. STEP 4 Enter the values.

IPv6 InterfaceSelect a specific port, LAG, VLAN, or ISATAP tunnel. Number of DAD AttemptsEnter the number of consecutive neighbor solicitation messages that are sent while Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) is performed on the interfaces Unicast IPv6 addresses. DAD verifies the uniqueness of a new Unicast IPv6 address before it is assigned. New addresses remain in a tentative state during DAD verification. Entering 0 in this field disables duplicate address detection processing on the specified interface. Entering 1 in this field indicates a single transmission without follow-up transmissions. IPv6 Address Auto ConfigurationEnable automatic address configuration. If enabled, the switch supports IPv6 stateless address auto configuration of site local and global IP address from the IPv6 router advertisement received on the interface. The switch does not support stateful address auto configuration. If auto-configuration is not enabled, define an IPv6 address from the IPv6 Addresses page.

217

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

16
Send ICMPv6 MessagesEnable generating unreachable destination messages.

STEP 5 Click Apply to enable IPv6 processing on the selected interface. Regular IPv6

interfaces have the following addresses automatically configured: Link local address using EUI-64 format interface ID based on a devices MAC address All node link local Multicast addresses (FF02::1) Solicited-Node Multicast address (format FF02::1:FFXX:XXXX)

STEP 6 Click IPv6 Address Table to manually assign IPv6 addresses to the interface, if

required. This page is described in the Defining IPv6 Addresses section.

Defining IPv6 Addresses


To assign an IPv6 address to an IPv6 Interface:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Management Interface > IPv6 Addresses

The IPv6 Addresses page appears.


STEP 2 To filter the table, select an interface name, and click Go. The interface appears in

the IPv6 Address Table.


STEP 3 Click Add. The Add IPv6 Address page appears. STEP 4 Enter values for the fields.

IPv6 InterfaceDisplays the interface on which the IPv6 address is to be defined. IPv6 Address TypeSelect Link Local or Global as the type of IPv6 address to add. Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

218

16

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

IPv6 AddressThe switch supports one IPv6 interface. In addition to the default link local and Multicast addresses, the device also automatically adds global addresses to the interface based on the router advertisements it receives. The device supports a maximum of 128 addresses at the interface. Each address must be a valid IPv6 address that is specified in hexadecimal format by using 16-bit values separated by colons.
NOTE You cannot configure an IPv6 addresses directly on an ISATAP tunnel

interface. Prefix LengthThe length of the Global IPv6 prefix is a value from 0-128 indicating the number of the high-order contiguous bits of the address comprise the prefix (the network portion of the address). EUI-64Select to use the EUI-64 parameter to identify the interface ID portion of the Global IPv6 address by using the EUI-64 format based on a device MAC address.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

Defining an IPv6 Default Router List


The IPv6 Default Router List page enables configuring and viewing the default IPv6 router addresses. This list contains the routers that are candidates to become the switch default router for non-local traffic (it may be empty). The switch randomly selects a router from the list. The switch supports one static IPv6 default router. Dynamic default routers are routers that have sent router advertisements to the switch IPv6 interface. When adding or deleting IP addresses, the following events occur: When removing an IP interface, all the default router IP addresses are removed. Dynamic IP addresses cannot be removed. An alert message appears after an attempt is made to insert more than a single user-defined address. An alert message appears when attempting to insert a non-link local type address, meaning 'fe80:'.

To define a default router:

219

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

16

STEP 1 Click Administration > Management Interface > IPv6 Default Router List .

The IPv6 Default Router List page appears. This page contains the following fields for each default router: Default Router IPv6 AddressLink local IP address of the default router. InterfaceOutgoing IPv6 interface where the default router resides. TypeThe default router configuration that includes the following options: StaticThe default router was manually added to this table through the Add button. DynamicThe default router was dynamically configured.

StateThe default router status options are: IncompleteAddress resolution is in process. Default router has not yet responded. ReachablePositive confirmation was received within the Reachable

Time.
StalePreviously-known neighboring network is unreachable, and no action is taken to verify its reachability until it is necessary to send traffic. DelayPreviously-known neighboring network is unreachable. The device is in Delay state for a predefined Delay Time. If no confirmation is received, the state changes to Probe. ProbeNeighboring network is unavailable, and Unicast Neighbor Solicitation probes are being sent to verify the status.

STEP 2 Click Add to add a static default router. The Add Default Router page appears.

The window contains the Link Local Interface. The interface can be a port, LAG, VLAN, or tunnel.
STEP 3 Enter the static default router IP address in the Default Router IPv6 Address field. STEP 4 Click Apply. The default router is written to the Running Configuration file.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

220

16
Configuring IPv6 Tunnels

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

The ISATAP (Intra-Site Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol) enables encapsulating IPv6 packets within IPv4 packets for transmission over IPv4 networks. To configure a tunnel, do the following: Manually enable and configure an ISATAP tunnel. Manually define an IPv6 interface for the ISATAP tunnel.

After these actions, the switch automatically configures the linklocal IPv6 address to the IPv6 interface. When defining ISATAP tunnels, note the following: An IPv6 link local address is assigned to the ISATAP interface. The initial IP address is assigned to the interface, which is then activated. If an ISATAP interface is active, the ISATAP router IPv4 address is resolved via DNS by using ISATAP-to-IPv4 mapping. If the ISATAP DNS record is not resolved, ISATAP host name-to-address mapping is searched in the host mapping table. When the ISATAP router IPv4 address is not resolved via the DNS process, the ISATAP IP interface remains active. The system does not have a default router for ISATAP traffic until the DNS process is resolved.

To configure an IPv6 Tunnel:


STEP 1 Click Administration > Management Interface > IPv6 Tunnel.

The IPv6 Tunnel page appears.


STEP 2 Enter values for the following fields:

Tunnel NumberDisplays the automatic tunnel router domain number. Tunnel TypeAlways displayed as ISATAP. Source IPv4 AddressDisable the ISATAP tunnel, or enable the ISATAP tunnel over an IPv4 interface. The IPv4 address of the selected IPv4 interface used to form part of the IPv6 address over the ISATAP tunnel interface. The IPv6 address has a 64-bit network prefix of fe80::, with the rest of the 64-bit formed by concatenating 0000:5EFE and the IPv4 address. -

AutoAutomatically selects the lowest IPv4 address from among all of


its configured IPv4 interfaces.

NoneDisable the ISATAP tunnel.


Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

221

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

16
-

ManualManually configure an IPv4 address. The IPv4 address


configured must be one of the IPv4 addresses at the switch IPv4 interfaces.

Tunnel Router's Domain NameA global string that represents a specific automatic tunnel router domain name. The name can either be the default name (ISATAP) or a user defined name. Query IntervalThe number of seconds from 10-3600 between DNS queries (before the IP address of the ISATAP router is known) for this tunnel. The interval can be the default value (10 seconds) or a user defined interval. ISATAP Solicitation IntervalThe number of seconds from 10-3600 between ISATAP router solicitations messages, when there is no active ISATAP router. The interval can be the default value (10 seconds) or a user defined interval. ISATAP RobustnessUsed to calculate the interval for the DNS or router solicitation queries. The bigger the number, the more frequent the queries.
NOTE The ISATAP tunnel is not operational if the underlying IPv4 interface is

not in operation.
STEP 3 Click Apply. The tunnel is written to the Running Configuration file.

Defining IPv6 Neighbors Information


The IPv6 Neighbors page enables configuring and viewing the list of IPv6 neighbors on the IPv6 interface. The IPv6 Neighbor Table (also known as IPv6 Neighbor Discovery Cache) contains the MAC addresses of the IPv6 neighbors that are in the same IPv6 subnet as the switch. This is used to verify the reachability of this neighbor. This is the IPv6 equivalent of the IPv4 ARP Table. When the switch needs to communicate with its neighbors, the switch uses the IPv6 Neighbor Table to determine the MAC addresses based on their IPv6 addresses. This page contains the neighbors that were automatically detected or manually configured entries. Each entry shows to which interface the neighbor is connected, the neighbors IPv6 and MAC addresses, the entry type (static or dynamic), and the state of the neighbor.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

222

16
To define IPv6 neighbors:

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

STEP 1 Click Administration > Management Interface > IPv6 Neighbors

The IPv6 Neighbors page appears.


STEP 2 You can select a Clear Table option to clear some or all of IPv6 addresses in the

IPv6 Neighbors Table. Static OnlyDeletes the static IPv6 address entries. Dynamic OnlyDeletes the dynamic IPv6 address entries. All Dynamic & StaticDeletes the static and dynamic address entries IPv6 address entries.

The following fields are displayed for the neighboring interfaces: InterfaceNeighboring IPv6 interface type. IPv6 AddressIPv6 address of a neighbor. MAC AddressMAC address mapped to the specified IPv6 address. TypeNeighbor discovery cache information entry type (static or dynamic). StateSpecifies the IPv6 neighbor status. The values are: -

IncompleteAddress resolution is working. The neighbor has not yet


responded.

ReachableNeighbor is known to be reachable. StalePreviously-known neighbor is unreachable. No action is taken to


verify its reachability until traffic must be sent.

DelayPreviously-known neighbor is unreachable. The interface is in


Delay state for a predefined Delay Time. If no reachability confirmation is received, the state changes to Probe.

ProbeNeighbor is no longer known to be reachable, and Unicast


Neighbor Solicitation probes are being sent to verify the reachability.

STEP 3 To add a neighbor to the table, click Add. The Add IPv6 Neighbors page appears. STEP 4 Enter values for the following fields:

InterfaceThe neighboring IPv6 interface to be added.

223

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

IP Configuration
Management and IP Interfaces

16
IPv6 AddressEnter the IPv6 network address assigned to the interface. The address must be a valid IPv6 address. MAC AddressEnter the MAC address mapped to the specified IPv6 address.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated. STEP 6 To change the type of an IP address from Dynamic to Static, use the Edit IPv6

Neighbors page.

Viewing IPv6 Route Tables


The IPv6 Routes page displays the IPv6 Routing Table. The table contains a single default route (IPv6 address:0) that uses the default router selected from the IPv6 Default Router List to send packets to destination devices that are not in the same IPv6 subnet as the switch. In addition to the default route, the table also contains dynamic routes that are ICMP redirect routes received from IPv6 routers by using ICMP redirect messages. This could happen when the default router the switch uses is not the router for traffic to which the IPv6 subnets that the switch wants to communicate. To view IPv6 routing entries:
STEP 1 Click Administration > Management Interface > IPv6 Routes.

The IPv6 Routes page appears. This page contains the following fields: IPv6 AddressThe IPv6 subnet address. Prefix LengthIP route prefix length for the destination IPv6 subnet address. It is preceded by a forward slash. InterfaceInterface used to forward the packet. Next HopAddress where the packet is forwarded. Typically, this is the address of a neighboring router. This must be a link local address. MetricValue used for comparing this route to other routes with the same destination in the IPv6 router table. All default routes have the same value. Life TimeTime period during which the packet can be sent, and resent, before being deleted.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

224

16
-

IP Configuration
Configuring ARP

Route TypeHow the destination is attached, and the method used to obtain the entry. The following values are:

LocalA directly-connected network whose prefix is derived from a


manually-configured switchs IPv6 address.

DynamicThe destination is an indirectly-attached (remote) IPv6 subnet


address. The entry was obtained dynamically via the ND or ICMP protocol.

StaticThe entry was manually configured by a user.

Configuring ARP
The switch maintains an ARP (Address Resolution Protocol) table for all known devices that reside in its directly-connected IP subnets. A directly-connected IP subnet is the subnet to which an IPv4 interface of the switch is connected. When the switch needs to send/route a packet to a local device, it searches the ARP table to obtain the MAC address of the device. The ARP table contains both static and dynamic addresses. Static addresses are manually configured and do not age out. The switch creates dynamic addresses from the ARP packets it receives. Dynamic addresses age out after a configured time.
NOTE The IP/MAC address mapping information in the ARP Table is used by the switch to

forward traffic originated by the switch. To define the ARP tables:


STEP 1 Click IP Configuration > ARP. The ARP Table page appears. STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

ARP Entry Age OutEnter the number of seconds that dynamic addresses can remain in the ARP table. A dynamic address ages out after the time it is in the table exceeds the ARP Entry Age Out time. When a dynamic address ages out, it is deleted from the table, and only returns when it is relearned. Clear ARP Table EntriesSelect the type of ARP entries to be cleared from the system. -

AllDeletes all of the static and dynamic addresses immediately. DynamicDeletes all of the dynamic addresses immediately.

225

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

IP Configuration
Domain Name Systems

16
-

StaticDeletes all of the static addresses immediately. Normal Age OutDeletes dynamic addresses based on the configured
ARP Entry Age Out time.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The ARP global settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

The ARP table contains the following fields: InterfaceThe IPv4 Interface of the directly-connected IP subnet where the IP device resides. IP AddressThe IP address of the IP device. MAC AddressThe MAC address of the IP device. StatusWhether the entry was manually entered or dynamically learned.

STEP 4 Click Add. The Add ARP Entry page appears. STEP 5 Enter the parameters:

IP VersionThe IP address format supported by the host. Only IPv4 is supported. InterfaceIPv4 interface on the switch.

There is only one directly-connected IP port, which is always in the management VLAN. All the static and dynamic addresses in the ARP Table reside in the management VLAN. IP AddressEnter the IP address of the local device. MAC AddressEnter the MAC address of the local device.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The ARP entry is written to the Running Configuration file.

Domain Name Systems


The Domain Name System (DNS) translates user-defined domain names into IP addresses for the purpose of locating and addressing these objects. As a DNS client the switch resolves domain names to IP addresses through one or more configured DNS servers.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

226

16
Defining DNS Servers

IP Configuration
Domain Name Systems

Use the DNS Servers page to enable the DNS feature, configure the DNS servers and set the default domain used by the switch.
STEP 1 Click IP Configuration > Domain Name System > DNS Servers. The DNS

Servers page appears.


STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

DNSSelect to designate the switch as a DNS client which resolves DNS names into IP addresses through one or more configured DNS servers. Default Domain NameEnter the default DNS domain name (1158 characters). The switch appends this to all non-fully qualified domain names (FQDNs) turning them into FQDNs. TypeDisplays the default domain type options: -

DHCPThe default domain name is dynamically assigned by the DHCP


server.

StaticThe default domain name is user-defined.


N/ANo default domain name.

DNS Server Table: DNS ServerThe IP addresses of the DNS servers. Up to eight DNS servers can be defined. Server StateThe DNS server state can be either active or inactive. There can be only one active server. Each static server has a priority, a lower value means a higher priority. When first time the request is sent, static server with lowest priority is chosen. If after two retries there is no response from this server, the next server with the next lowest priority is selected. If none of the static servers respond, the first dynamic server on the table, sorted by IP address (low to high), is selected.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated. STEP 4 To add a DNS server, click Add. The Add DNS Server page appears. STEP 5 Enter the parameters.

IP VersionSelect Version 6 for IPv6 or Version 4 for IPv4. IPv6 Address TypeSelect the IPv6 address type (if IPv6 is used). The options are:
Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

227

IP Configuration
Domain Name Systems

16
Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

Link Local InterfaceIf the IPv6 address type is Link Local, select whether it is received through VLAN2 or ISATAP. DNS Server IP AddressEnter the DNS server IP address. Set DNS Server ActiveSelect to activate the new DNS server.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The DNS server is written to the Running Configuration file.

Mapping DNS Hosts


The switch saves frequently-queried domain names acquired from the DNS servers in a local DNS cache. The cache can hold up to 64 static entries, 64 dynamic entries, and one entry for each IP address configured on the switch by DHCP. Name resolution always begins by checking static entries, continues by checking the dynamic entries, and ends by sending requests to the external DNS server. Several IP addresses are supported per DNS per host name. To add a domain name and its IP address:
STEP 1 Click IP Configuration > Domain Name System > Host Mapping. The Host

Mapping page appears. This page contains the following fields: Host NameUser-defined domain name, up to 158 characters. IP AddressThe host name IP address.

STEP 2 To add a host mapping, click Add. The Add Host Mapping page appears. STEP 3 Enter the parameters.

IP VersionSelect Version 6 for IPv6 or Version 4 for IPv4.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

228

16
-

IP Configuration
Domain Name Systems

IPv6 Address TypeSelect the IPv6 address type (if IPv6 is used). The options are: Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

Link Local InterfaceIf the IPv6 address type is Link Local, select whether it is received through VLAN2 or ISATAP. Host NameEnter a domain name, up to 158 characters. IP AddressEnter an IPv4 address or enter up to four IPv6 host addresses. Addresses 24 are backup addresses.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The DNS server is written to the Running Configuration file.

229

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

IP Configuration
Domain Name Systems

16

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

230

17
Security
This section describes switch security and access control. The system handles various types of security. The following list of topics describes the various types of security features described in this section. Some features are used for more than a single type of security or control, and so they appear twice in the list of topics below. Permission to administer the switch is described in the following sections: Defining Users Configuring RADIUS Configuring Management Access Authentication Defining Management Access Method Configuring TCP/UDP Services

Protection from attacks directed at the switch CPU is described in the following sections: Configuring TCP/UDP Services Defining Storm Control

Access control of end-users to the network through the switch is described in the following sections: Configuring Management Access Authentication Defining Management Access Method Configuring RADIUS Configuring Port Security Configuring 802.1X

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

231

Security
Defining Users

17
Protection from other network users is described in the following sections. These are attacks that pass through, but are not directed at, the switch. Denial of Service Prevention Configuring TCP/UDP Services Defining Storm Control Configuring Port Security

Defining Users
The default username/password is cisco/cisco. The first time that you log in with the default username and password, you are required to enter a new password. Password complexity is enabled by default. If the password that you choose is not complex enough (Password Complexity Settings are enabled in the Password Strength page), you are prompted to create another password.

Setting User Accounts


The User Accounts page enables entering additional users that are permitted to access to the switch (read-only or read-write) or changing the passwords of existing users. After adding a user (as described below), the default user is removed from the system.
NOTE It is not permitted to delete all users. If all users are selected, the Delete button is

disabled. To add a new user:


STEP 1 Click Administration > User Accounts. The User Accounts page appears.

This page contains the users defined in the system and their user privilege level.
STEP 2 Select Password Recovery Service to enable this feature. When this is enabled, an

end user, with physical access to the console port of the device, can enter the boot menu and trigger the password recovery process. When the boot system process ends, you are allowed to login to the device without password authentication. Entering the device is allowed only via the console and only when the console is connected to the device with physical access.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

232

17

Security
Defining Users

When password recovery mechanism is disabled, accessing the boot menu is still allowed and you can trigger the password recovery process. The difference is that in this case, all configuration and user files are removed during the system boot process, and a suitable log message is generated to the terminal.
STEP 3 Click Add to add a new user or click Edit to modify a user. The Add (or Edit) a User

Account page appears.


STEP 4 Enter the parameters.

User NameEnter a new username between 0 and 20 characters. UTF-8 characters are not permitted. PasswordEnter a password (UTF-8 characters are not permitted). If the password strength and complexity is defined, the user password must comply with the policy configured in the Setting Password Complexity Rules section. Confirm PasswordEnter the password again. Password Strength MeterDisplays the strength of password. The policy for password strength and complexity are configured in the Password Strength page.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The user is added to the Running Configuration file of the switch.

Setting Password Complexity Rules


Passwords are used to authenticate users accessing the switch. Simple passwords are potential security hazards. Therefore, password complexity requirements are enforced by default and may be configured as necessary. Password complexity requirements are configured on the Password Strength page reached through the Security drop-down menu. Additionally, password aging time may be configured on this page. To define password complexity rules:
STEP 1 Click Security > Password Strength. The Password Strength page appears. STEP 2 Enter the following aging parameters for passwords:

Password AgingIf selected, the user is prompted to change the password when the Password Aging Time expires.

233

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Defining Users

17
Password Aging TimeEnter the number of days that can elapse before the user is prompted to change the password.
NOTE Password aging also applies to zero-length passwords (no

password).
STEP 3 Select Password Complexity Settings to enable complexity rules for passwords.

If password complexity is enabled, new passwords must conform to the following default settings: Have a minimum length of eight characters. Contain characters from at least three character classes (uppercase letters, lowercase letters, numbers, and special characters available on a standard keyboard). Are different from the current password. Contain no character that is repeated more than three times consecutively. Do not repeat or reverse the users name or any variant reached by changing the case of the characters. Do not repeat or reverse the manufacturers name or any variant reached by changing the case of the characters.

STEP 4 If the Password Complexity Settings are enabled, the following parameters may

be configured: Minimal Password LengthEnter the minimal number of characters required for passwords.
NOTE A zero-length password (no password) is allowed, and can still have

password aging assigned to it. Allowed Character RepetitionEnter the number of times that a character can be repeated. Minimal Number of Character ClassesEnter the number of character classes which must be present in a password. Character classes are lower case (1), upper case (2), digits (3), and symbols or special characters (4). The New Password Must Be Different than the Current OneIf selected, the new password cannot be the same as the current password upon a password change.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

234

17

Security
Configuring RADIUS

STEP 5 Click Apply. The password settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

Configuring RADIUS
Remote Authorization Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) servers provide a centralized 802.1X or MAC-based network access control. The switch is a RADIUS client that can use a RADIUS server to provide centralized security. An organization can establish a Remote Authorization Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) server to provide centralized 802.1X or MAC-based network access control for all of its devices. In this way, authentication and authorization can be handled on a single server for all devices in the organization. The switch can act as a RADIUS client that uses the RADIUS server for the following services: AuthenticationProvides authentication of regular and 802.1X users logging onto the switch by using usernames and user-defined passwords. AuthorizationPerformed at login. After the authentication session is completed, an authorization session starts using the authenticated username. The TACACS+ server then checks user privileges. AccountingEnable accounting of login sessions using the TACACS+ server. This enables a system administrator to generate accounting reports on the TACACS+ server.

Accounting Using a RADIUS Server


The user can enable accounting of login sessions using either a RADIUS or TACACS+ server. The user-configurable, TCP port used for RADIUS server accounting is the same TCP port that is used for RADIUS server authentication and authorization.

Defaults
The following defaults are relevant to this feature: No default RADIUS server is defined by default.

235

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Configuring RADIUS

17
If you configure a RADIUS server, the accounting feature is disabled by default.

Interactions With Other Features


You cannot enable accounting on both a RADIUS and TACACS+ server.

Workflow
To user a RADIUS server, do the following:
STEP 1 Open an account for the switch on the RADIUS server. STEP 2 Configure that server along with the other parameters in the RADIUS and ADD

RADIUS Server pages.


NOTE If more than one RADIUS server has been configured, the device uses the

configured priorities of the available RADIUS servers to select the RADIUS server to be used by the device. To set the RADIUS server parameters:
STEP 1 Click Security > RADIUS. The RADIUS page appears. STEP 2 Enter the default RADIUS parameters if required. Values entered in the Default

Parameters are applied to all servers. If a value is not entered for a specific server (in the Add RADIUS Server page) the switch uses the values in these fields. IP VersionDisplays the supported IP versions: IPv6 and/or IPv4 subnet. RetriesEnter the number of transmitted requests that are sent to the RADIUS server before a failure is considered to have occurred. Timeout for ReplyEnter the number of seconds that the switch waits for an answer from the RADIUS server before retrying the query, or switching to the next server. Dead TimeEnter the number of minutes that elapse before a nonresponsive RADIUS server is bypassed for service requests. If the value is 0, the server is not bypassed. Key StringEnter the default key string used for authenticating and encrypting between the switch and the RADIUS server. This key must match the key configured on the RADIUS server. A key string is used to encrypt communications by using MD5. The key can be entered in Encrypted or

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

236

17

Security
Configuring RADIUS

Plaintext form. If you do not have an encrypted key string (from another device), enter the key string in plaintext mode and click Apply. The encrypted key string is generated and displayed. This overrides the default key string if one has been defined. Source IPv4 AddressEnter the source IPv4 address to be used. Source IPv6 AddressEnter the source IPv6 address to be used.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The RADIUS default settings for the switch are updated in the Running

Configuration file. To add a RADIUS server, click Add. The Add RADIUS Server page appears.
STEP 4 Enter the values in the fields for each RADIUS server. To use the default values

entered in the RADIUS page, select Use Default . Server DefinitionSelect whether to specify the RADIUS server by IP address or name. IP VersionIf the RADIUS server is to be identified by IP address, select either IPv4 or IPv6, to indicate that it is entered in the selected format. IPv6 Address TypeDisplays that IPv6 address type is Global. IPv6 Address TypeSelect the IPv6 address type (if IPv6 is used). The options are: Link LocalThe IPv6 address uniquely identifies hosts on a single network link. A link local address has a prefix of FE80, is not routable, and can be used for communication only on the local network. Only one link local address is supported. If a link local address exists on the interface, this entry replaces the address in the configuration. GlobalThe IPv6 address is a global Unicast IPV6 type that is visible and reachable from other networks.

Link Local InterfaceSelect the link local interface (if IPv6 Address Type Link Local is selected) from the list. Server IP Address/NameEnter the RADIUS server by IP address or name. PriorityEnter the priority of the server. The priority determines the order the switch attempts to contact the servers to authenticate a user. The switch starts with the highest priority RADIUS server first. Zero is the highest priority.

237

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Configuring RADIUS

17
Key StringEnter the key string used for authenticating and encrypting communication between the switch and the RADIUS server. This key must match the key configured on the RADIUS server. It can be entered in Encrypted or Plaintext format. If Use Default is selected, the switch attempts to authenticate to the RADIUS server by using the default Key String. Timeout for ReplyEnter the number of seconds the switch waits for an answer from the RADIUS server before retrying the query, or switching to the next server if the maximum number of retries were made. If Use Default is selected, the switch uses the default timeout value. Authentication PortEnter the UDP port number of the RADIUS server port for authentication requests. RetriesEnter the number of requests that are sent to the RADIUS server before a failure is considered to have occurred. If Use Default is selected, the switch uses the default value for the number of retries. Dead TimeEnter the number of minutes that must pass before a nonresponsive RADIUS server is bypassed for service requests. If Use Default is selected, the switch uses the default value for the dead time. If you enter 0 minutes, there is no dead time. Usage TypeEnter the RADIUS server authentication type. The options are: LoginRADIUS server is used for authenticating users that ask to administer the switch. 802.1XRADIUS server is used for 802.1x authentication. AllRADIUS server is used for authenticating user that ask to administer the switch and for 802.1X authentication.

STEP 5 To display sensitive data in plaintext form in the configuration file, click Display

Sensitive Data As Plaintext .


STEP 6 Click Apply. The RADIUS server definition is added to the Running Configuration

file of the switch.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

238

17

Security
Configuring Management Access Authentication

Configuring Management Access Authentication


Authentication methods can be assigned to HTTP/HTTPS sessions. The authentication can be performed locally or on a RADIUS server. For the RADIUS server to grant access to the web-based configuration utility, the RADIUS server must return cisco-avpair = shell:priv-lvl=15. User authentication occurs in the order that the authentication methods are selected. If the first authentication method is not available, the next selected method is used. For example, if the selected authentication methods are RADIUS and Local, and all configured RADIUS servers are queried in priority order and do not reply, the user is authenticated locally. If an authentication method fails or the user has insufficient privilege level, the user is denied access to the switch. In other words, if authentication fails at an authentication method, the switch stops the authentication attempt; it does not continue and does not attempt to use the next authentication method. To define authentication methods for an access method:
STEP 1 Click Security > Management Access Authentication. The Management Access

Authentication page appears.


STEP 2 Select an access method from the Application list. STEP 3 Use the arrows to move the authentication method between the Optional Methods

column and the Selected Methods column. The first method selected is the first method that is used. RADIUSUser is authenticated on a RADIUS server. You must have configured one or more RADIUS servers. NoneUser is allowed to access the switch without authentication. LocalUsername and password are checked against the data stored on the local switch. These username and password pairs are defined in the User Accounts page.
NOTE The Local or None authentication method must always be

selected last. All authentication methods selected after Local or None are ignored.
STEP 4 Click Apply. The selected authentication methods are associated with the access

method.

239

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Defining Management Access Method

17

Defining Management Access Method


Access profiles determine how to authenticate and authorize users accessing the switch through various access methods. Access Profiles can limit management access from specific sources. Only users who pass both the active access profile and the management access authentication methods are given management access to the switch. There can only be a single access profile active on the switch at one time. Access profiles consist of one or more rules. The rules are executed in order of their priority within the access profile (top to bottom). Rules are composed of filters that include the following elements: Access MethodsMethods for accessing and managing the switch: Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Secure HTTP (HTTPS) All of the above

ActionPermit or deny access to an interface or source address. InterfaceWhich ports, LAGs, or VLANs are permitted to access or are denied access to the web-based configuration utility. Source IP AddressIP addresses or subnets that are allowed access.

Active Access Profile


The Access Profiles page contains the access profiles that are defined and enables selecting one access profile to be the active one. When a user attempts to access the switch through an access method, the switch looks to see if the active access profile explicitly permits management access to the switch through this method. If no match is found, access is denied. When an attempt to access the switch is in violation of the active access profile, the switch generates a SYSLOG message to alert the system administrator of the attempt. For more information see Defining Profile Rules.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

240

17

Security
Defining Management Access Method

Use the Access Profiles page to create an access profile and to add its first rule. If the access profile only contains a single rule, you are finished. To add additional rules to the profile, use the Profile Rules page.
STEP 1 Click Security > Mgmt Access Method > Access Profiles. The Access Profiles

page appears. This page contains all of the access profiles, active and inactive.
STEP 2 To change the active access profile, select a profile from the Active Access

Profile drop down menu and click Apply. This makes the chosen profile the active access profile. A caution message appears if you selected any other access profile, warning you that, depending on the selected access profile, you might be disconnected from the web-based configuration utility.
STEP 3 Click OK to select the active access profile or click Cancel to discontinue the

action.
STEP 4 Click Add to open the Add Access Profile page. The page allows you to configure

a new profile and one rule.


STEP 5 Enter the Access Profile Name. This name can contain up to 32 characters. STEP 6 Enter the parameters.

Rule PriorityEnter the rule priority. When the packet is matched to a rule, user groups are either granted or denied access to the switch. The rule priority is essential to matching packets to rules, as packets are matched on a first-match basis. One is the highest priority. Management MethodSelect the management method for which the rule is defined. The options are: AllAssigns all management methods to the rule. HTTP Users requesting access to the switch that meets the HTTP access profile criteria, are permitted or denied. Secure HTTP (HTTPS)Users requesting access to the switch that meets the HTTPS access profile criteria, are permitted or denied.

ActionSelect the action attached to the rule. The options are: PermitPermits access to the switch if the user matches the settings in the profile.

241

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Defining Management Access Method

17
DenyDenies access to the switch if the user matches the settings in the profile.

Applies to InterfaceSelect the interface attached to the rule. The options are: AllApplies to all ports, VLANs, and LAGs. User DefinedApplies to selected interface.

InterfaceEnter the interface number if User Defined was selected. Applies to Source IP AddressSelect the type of source IP address to which the access profile applies. The Source IP Address field is valid for a subnetwork. Select one of the following values: AllApplies to all types of IP addresses. User DefinedApplies to only those types of IP addresses defined in the fields.

IP VersionSelect the supported IP version of the source address, IPv6 or IPv4. IP AddressEnter the source IP address. MaskSelect the format for the subnet mask for the source IP address, and enter a value in one of the fields: -

Network MaskSelect the subnet to which the source IP address


belongs and enter the subnet mask in dotted decimal format.

Prefix LengthSelect the Prefix Length and enter the number of bits that
comprise the source IP address prefix.

STEP 7 Click Apply. The access profile is written to the Running Configuration file. You can

now select this access profile as the active access profile.

Defining Profile Rules


Access profiles can contain up to 128 rules to determine who is permitted to manage and access the switch, and the access methods that may be used.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

242

17

Security
Defining Management Access Method

Each rule in an access profile contains an action and criteria (one or more parameters) to match. Each rule has a priority; rules with the lowest priority are checked first. If the incoming packet matches a rule, the action associated with the rule is performed. If no matching rule is found within the active access profile, the packet is dropped. For example, you can limit access to the switch from all IP addresses except IP addresses that are allocated to the IT management center. In this way, the switch can still be managed and has gained another layer of security. To add profile rules to an access profile:
STEP 1 Click Security > Mgmt Access Method > Profile Rules. The Profiles Rules page

appears.
STEP 2 Select the Filter field, and an access profile. Click Go.

The selected access profile appears in the Profile Rule Table.


STEP 3 Click Add to add a rule to it. The Add Profile Rule page appears. STEP 4 Enter the parameters.

Access Profile NameSelect an access profile. Rule PriorityEnter the rule priority. When the packet is matched to a rule, user groups are either granted or denied access to the switch. The rule priority is essential to matching packets to rules, as packets are matched on a first-fit basis. Management MethodSelect the management method for which the rule is defined. The options are: AllAssigns all management methods to the rule. HTTPAssigns HTTP access to the rule. Users requesting access to the switch that meets the HTTP access profile criteria, are permitted or denied. Secure HTTP (HTTPS)Users requesting access to the switch that meets the HTTPS access profile criteria, are permitted or denied.

ActionSelect Permit to permit the users that attempt to access the switch by using the configured access method from the interface and IP source defined in this rule. Or select Deny to deny access. Applies to InterfaceSelect the interface attached to the rule. The options are:

243

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Configuring TCP/UDP Services

17
AllApplies to all ports, VLANs, and LAGs. User DefinedApplies only to the port, VLAN, or LAG selected. InterfaceEnter the interface number. Applies to Source IP AddressSelect the type of source IP address to which the access profile applies. The Source IP Address field is valid for a subnetwork. Select one of the following values: AllApplies to all types of IP addresses. User DefinedApplies to only those types of IP addresses defined in the fields.

IP VersionSelect the supported IP version of the source address: IPv6 or IPv4. IP AddressEnter the source IP address. MaskSelect the format for the subnet mask for the source IP address, and enter a value in one of the field: Network MaskSelect the subnet to which the source IP address belongs and enter the subnet mask in dotted decimal format. Prefix LengthSelect the Prefix Length and enter the number of bits that comprise the source IP address prefix.

STEP 5 Click Apply, and the rule is added to the access profile.

Configuring TCP/UDP Services


The TCP/UDP Services page enables TCP or UDP-based services on the switch, usually for security reasons. The switch offers the following TCP/UDP services: HTTPEnabled by factory default HTTPSEnabled by factory default

The active TCP connections are also displayed in this window. To configure TCP/UDP services:

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

244

17

Security
Configuring TCP/UDP Services

STEP 1 Click Security > TCP/UDP Services. The TCP/UDP Services page appears. STEP 2 Enable or disable the following TCP/UDP services on the displayed services.

HTTP ServiceIndicates whether the HTTP service is enabled or disabled. HTTPS ServiceIndicates whether the HTTPS service is enabled or disabled.

The TCP Service Table contains the following fields for each service: Service NameAccess method through which the switch is offering the TCP service. TypeIP protocol the service uses. Local IP AddressLocal IP address through which the switch is offering the service. Local PortLocal TCP port through which the switch is offering the service. Remote IP AddressIP address of the remote device that is requesting the service. Remote PortTCP port of the remote device that is requesting the service. StateStatus of the service.

The UDP Services table contains the following information: Service NameAccess method through which the switch is offering the UDP service. TypeIP protocol the service uses. Local IP AddressLocal IP address through which the switch is offering the service. Local PortLocal UDP port through which the switch is offering the service. Application InstanceThe service instance of the UDP service. (For example, when two senders send data to the same destination.)

STEP 3 Click Apply. The services are written to the Running Configuration file.

245

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Defining Storm Control

17
When Broadcast, Multicast, or Unknown Unicast frames are received, they are duplicated, and a copy is sent to all possible egress ports. This means that in practice they are sent to all ports belonging to the relevant VLAN. In this way, one ingress frame is turned into many, creating the potential for a traffic storm. Storm protection enables you to limit the number of frames entering the switch and to define the types of frames that are counted towards this limit. When the rate of Broadcast, Multicast, or Unknown Unicast frames is higher than the user-defined threshold, frames received beyond the threshold are discarded. To define Storm Control:

Defining Storm Control

STEP 1 Click Security > Storm Control. The Storm Control page appears.

All the fields on this page are described in the Edit Storm Control page except for the Storm Control Rate Threshold (%). It shows the percent of the total available bandwidth for unknown Unicast, Multicast, and Broadcast packets before storm control is applied at the port. The default value is 10% of the maximum rate of the port and is set in the Edit Storm Control page.
STEP 2 Select a port and click Edit. The Edit Storm Control page appears. STEP 3 Enter the parameters.

InterfaceSelect the port for which storm control is enabled. Storm ControlSelect to enable Storm Control. Storm Control Rate ThresholdEnter the maximum rate at which unknown packets can be forwarded. The default for this threshold is 10,000 for FE devices and 100,000 for GE devices. Storm Control ModeSelect one of the modes: Unknown Unicast, Multicast & BroadcastCounts unknown Unicast, Broadcast, and Multicast traffic towards the bandwidth threshold. Multicast & BroadcastCounts Broadcast and Multicast traffic towards the bandwidth threshold. Broadcast OnlyCounts only Broadcast traffic towards the bandwidth threshold.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

246

17
updated.

Security
Configuring Port Security

STEP 4 Click Apply. Storm control is modified, and the Running Configuration file is

Configuring Port Security


Network security can be increased by limiting access on a port to users with specific MAC addresses. The MAC addresses can be either dynamically learned or statically configured. Port security monitors received and learned packets. Access to locked ports is limited to users with specific MAC addresses. Port Security has four modes: Classic LockAll learned MAC addresses on the port are locked, and the port does not learn any new MAC addresses. The learned addresses are not subject to aging or re-learning. Limited Dynamic LockThe switch learns MAC addresses up to the configured limit of allowed addresses. After the limit is reached, the switch does not learn additional addresses. In this mode, the addresses are subject to aging and re-learning. Secure PermanentKeeps the current dynamic MAC addresses associated with the port and learns up to the maximum number of addresses allowed on the port (set by Max No. of Addresses Allowed). Relearning and aging are enabled. Secure Delete on ResetDeletes the current dynamic MAC addresses associated with the port after reset. New MAC addresses can be learned as Delete-On-Reset ones up to the maximum addresses allowed on the port. Relearning and aging are disabled.

When a frame from a new MAC address is detected on a port where it is not authorized (the port is classically locked, and there is a new MAC address, or the port is dynamically locked, and the maximum number of allowed addresses has been exceeded), the protection mechanism is invoked, and one of the following actions can take place: Frame is discarded Frame is forwarded

247

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Configuring Port Security

17
Port is shut down When the secure MAC address is seen on another port, the frame is forwarded, but the MAC address is not learned on that port. In addition to one of these actions, you can also generate traps, and limit their frequency and number to avoid overloading the devices.

NOTE Traps are SYSLOG-related traps, not generated through SNMP. NOTE To use 802.1X on a port, it must be in multiple host or multi session modes. Port

security on a port cannot be set if the port is in single mode (see the Defining Host and Session Authentication page). To configure port security:
STEP 1 Click Security > Port Security. The Port Security page appears. Port Security

Page
STEP 2 Select an interface to be modified, and click Edit. The Edit Port Security Interface

Settings page appears.


STEP 3 Enter the parameters.

InterfaceSelect the interface name. Interface StatusSelect to lock the port. Learning ModeSelect the type of port locking. To configure this field, the Interface Status must be unlocked. The Learning Mode field is enabled only if the Interface Status field is locked. To change the Learning Mode, the Lock Interface must be cleared. After the mode is changed, the Lock Interface can be reinstated. The options are: Classic LockLocks the port immediately, regardless of the number of addresses that have already been learned. Limited Dynamic LockLocks the port by deleting the current dynamic MAC addresses associated with the port. The port learns up to the maximum addresses allowed on the port. Both re-learning and aging of MAC addresses are enabled. Secure PermanentKeeps the current dynamic MAC addresses associated with the port and learns up to the maximum number of addresses allowed on the port (set by Max No. of Addresses Allowed). Relearning and aging are enabled.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

248

17
-

Security
Configuring 802.1X

Secure Delete on ResetDeletes the current dynamic MAC addresses associated with the port after reset. New MAC addresses can be learned as Delete-On-Reset ones up to the maximum addresses allowed on the port. Relearning and aging are disabled.

Max No. of Addresses AllowedEnter the maximum number of MAC addresses that can be learned on the port if Limited Dynamic Lock learning mode is selected. The number 0 indicates that only static addresses are supported on the interface. Action on ViolationSelect an action to be applied to packets arriving on a locked port. The options are: DiscardDiscards packets from any unlearned source. ForwardForwards packets from an unknown source without learning the MAC address. ShutdownDiscards packets from any unlearned source, and shuts down the port. The port remains shut down until reactivated, or until the switch is rebooted.

TrapSelect to enable traps when a packet is received on a locked port. This is relevant for lock violations. For Classic Lock, this is any new address received. For Limited Dynamic Lock, this is any new address that exceeds the number of allowed addresses.
NOTE Traps are SYSLOG-related and not generated through SNMP.

Trap FrequencyEnter minimum time (in seconds) that elapses between traps.

STEP 4 Click Apply. Port security is modified, and the Running Configuration file is

updated.

Configuring 802.1X
Port-based access control has the effect of creating two types of access on the switch ports. One point of access enables uncontrolled communication, regardless of the authorization state (uncontrolled port). The other point of access authorizes communication between a host and the switch.

249

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Configuring 802.1X

17
The 802.1x is an IEEE standard for port-based network access control. The 802.1x framework enables a device (the supplicant) to request port access from a remote device (authenticator) to which it is connected. Only when the supplicant requesting port access is authenticated and authorized is it permitted to send data to the port. Otherwise, the authenticator discards the supplicant data. Authentication of the supplicant is performed by an external RADIUS server through the authenticator. The authenticator monitors the result of the authentication. In the 802.1x standard, a device can be a supplicant and an authenticator at a port simultaneously, requesting port access and granting port access. However, this device is only the authenticator, and does not take on the role of a supplicant. The following varieties of 802.1X exist: Single session 802.1X: Single-session/single hostIn this mode, the switch, as an authenticator, supports a single 802.1x session and grants permission to use the port to the authorized supplicant. All access by other devices received from the same port are denied until the authorized supplicant is no longer using the port or the access is to the unauthenticated VLAN. Single session/multiple hostsThis follows the 802.1x standard. In this mode, the switch as an authenticator allows any device to use a port as long as it has been granted permission.

Multi-Session 802.1XEvery device (supplicant) connecting to a port must be authenticated and authorized by the switch (authenticator) separately in a different 802.1x session.

The switch supports the 802.1x authentication mechanism, as described in the standard, to authenticate and authorize 802.1x supplicants.

802.1X Parameters Workflow


Define the 802.1X parameters as follows: (Optional) Define one or more static VLANs as unauthenticated VLANs as described in the Defining 802.1X Properties section. 802.1x authorized and unauthorized devices or ports can always send or receive packets to or from unauthenticated VLANs. Define 802.1X settings for each port by using the Edit Port Authentication page.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

250

17
Note the following:

Security
Configuring 802.1X

You can select the Guest VLAN field to have untagged incoming frames go to the guest VLAN. Define host authentication parameters for each port using the Port Authentication page. View 802.1X authentication history using the Authenticated Hosts page.

Defining 802.1X Properties


The 802.1X Properties page is used to globally enable 802.1X and define how ports are authenticated. For 802.1X to function, it must be activated both globally and individually on each port. To define port-based authentication:
STEP 1 Click Security > 802.1X > Properties. The Properties page appears. STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

Port-Based AuthenticationEnable or disable port-based, 802.1X authentication. Authentication MethodSelect the user authentication methods. The options are: RADIUS, NonePerform port authentication first by using the RADIUS server. If no response is received from RADIUS (for example, if the server is down), then no authentication is performed, and the session is permitted. RADIUSAuthenticate the user on the RADIUS server. If no authentication is performed, the session is not permitted. NoneDo not authenticate the user. Permit the session.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The 802.1X properties are written to the Running Configuration file.

251

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Configuring 802.1X

17
Defining 802.1X Port Authentication
The Port Authentication page enables configuration of 802.1X parameters for each port. Since some of the configuration changes are only possible while the port is in Force Authorized state, such as host authentication, it is recommended that you change the port control to Force Authorized before making changes. When the configuration is complete, return the port control to its previous state.
NOTE A port with 802.1x defined on it cannot become a member of a LAG.

To define 802.1X authentication:


STEP 1 Click Security > 802.1X > Port Authentication. The Port Authentication page

appears. This page contains authentication settings for all ports.


STEP 2 Select a port, and click Edit. The Edit Port Authentication page appears. STEP 3 Enter the parameters.

InterfaceSelect a port. User NameDisplays the username. Current Port ControlDisplays the current port authorization state. If the state is Authorized, the port is either authenticated or the Administrative Port Control is Force Authorized. Conversely, if the state is Unauthorized, then the port is either not authenticated or the Administrative Port Control is Force Unauthorized. Administrative Port ControlSelect the Administrative Port Authorization state. The options are: Force UnauthorizedDenies the interface access by moving the interface into the unauthorized state. The switch does not provide authentication services to the client through the interface. AutoEnables port-based authentication and authorization on the switch. The interface moves between an authorized or unauthorized state based on the authentication exchange between the switch and the client. Force AuthorizedAuthorizes the interface without authentication.

Authentication MethodSelect the authentication method for the port. The options are:

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

252

17

Security
Configuring 802.1X

802.1X Only802.1X authentication is the only authentication method performed on the port.

Periodic ReauthenticationSelect to enable port re-authentication attempts after the specified Reauthentication Period. Reauthentication PeriodEnter the number of seconds after which the selected port is reauthenticated. Reauthenticate NowSelect to enable immediate port re-authentication. Authenticator StateDisplays the defined port authorization state. The options are: InitializeIn process of coming up. Force-AuthorizedControlled port state is set to Force-Authorized (forward traffic).
NOTE If the port is not in Force-Unauthorized, it is in Auto Mode and the

authenticator shows the state of the authentication in progress. After the port is authenticated, the state is shown as Authenticated. Quiet PeriodEnter the number of seconds that the switch remains in the quiet state following a failed authentication exchange. Resending EAPEnter the number of seconds that the switch waits for a response to an Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP) request/identity frame from the supplicant (client) before resending the request. Max EAP RequestsEnter the maximum number of EAP requests that can be sent. If a response is not received after the defined period (supplicant timeout), the authentication process is restarted. Supplicant TimeoutEnter the number of seconds that lapses before EAP requests are resent to the supplicant. Server TimeoutEnter the number of seconds that lapses before the switch resends a request to the authentication server. Termination CauseDisplays the reason for which port authentication was terminated, if applicable.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The port settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

253

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Configuring 802.1X

17
Defining Host and Session Authentication
The Host and Session Authentication page enables defining the mode in which 802.1X operates on the port and the action to perform if a violation has been detected. The 802.1X modes are: SingleOnly a single authorized host can access the port. (Port Security cannot be enabled on a port in single-host mode.) Multiple Host (802.1X)Multiple hosts can be attached to a single 802.1Xenabled port. Only the first host must be authorized, and then the port is open for all who want to access the network. If the host authentication fails, or an EAPOL-logoff message is received, all attached clients are denied access to the network. Multiple SessionsEnables the number of specific authorized hosts to access the port. Each host is treated as if it were the first and only user and must be authenticated. Filtering is based on the source MAC address.

To define 802.1X advanced settings for ports:


STEP 1 Click Security > 802.1X > Host and Session Authentication. The Host and

Session Authentication page appears. 802.1X authentication parameters are described for all ports. All fields except the following are described in the Edit Host and Session Authentication page. StatusDisplays the host status. An asterisk indicates that the port is either not linked or is down. The options are: UnauthorizedEither the port control is Force Unauthorized and the port link is down, or the port control is Auto but a client has not been authenticated via the port. Force-AuthorizedClients have full port access. Single-host LockPort control is Auto and only a single client has been authenticated by using the port. No Single HostPort control is Auto and Multiple Hosts mode is enabled. At least one client has been authenticated. Not in Auto ModeAuto port control is not enabled.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

254

17

Security
Configuring 802.1X

Number of ViolationsDisplays the number of packets that arrive on the interface in single-host mode, from a host whose MAC address is not the supplicant MAC address.

STEP 2 Select a port, and click Edit. The Edit Host and Session Authentication page

appears.
STEP 3 Enter the parameters.

InterfaceEnter a port number for which host authentication is enabled. Host AuthenticationSelect one of the modes. These modes are described above in Defining Host and Session Authentication.
NOTE The following fields are only relevant if you select Single in the Host

Authentication field. Single Host Violation Settings: Action on ViolationSelect the action to be applied to packets arriving in Single Session/Single Host mode, from a host whose MAC address is not the supplicant MAC address. The options are: Protect (Discard)Discards the packets. Restrict (Forward)Forwards the packets. ShutdownDiscards the packets and shuts down the port. The ports remains shut down until reactivated, or until the switch is rebooted.

Traps (on single host violation)Select to enable traps.


NOTE Traps are SYSLOG-related and not SNMP-related.

Trap Frequency (on Single Host Violation)Defines how often traps are sent to the host. This field can be defined only if multiple hosts are disabled.

STEP 4 Click Apply. The settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

Viewing Authenticated Hosts


To view details about authenticated users:

255

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Denial of Service Prevention

17

STEP 1 Click Security > 802.1X > Authenticated Hosts. The Authenticated Hosts page

appears. This page contains the following fields: User NameSupplicant names that were authenticated on each port. PortNumber of the port. Session Time (DD:HH:MM:SS)Amount of time that the supplicant was logged on the port. Authentication MethodMethod by which the last session was authenticated. The options are: NoneNo authentication is applied; it is automatically authorized. RADIUSSupplicant was authenticated by a RADIUS server.

MAC AddressDisplays the supplicant MAC address.

Denial of Service Prevention


A Denial of Service (DoS) attack is a hacker attempt to make a device unavailable to its users. DoS attacks saturate the device with external communication requests, so that it cannot respond to legitimate traffic. These attacks usually lead to a device CPU overload.

Secure Core Technology (SCT)


One method of resisting DoS attacks employed by the device is the use of SCT. SCT is enabled by default on the device and cannot be disabled. The Cisco device is an advanced switch that handles management traffic, protocol traffic and snooping traffic, in addition to end-user (TCP) traffic. SCT ensures that the switch receives and processes management and protocol traffic, no matter how much total traffic is received. This is done by rate-limiting TCP traffic to the CPU. There are no interactions with other features.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

256

17

Security
Denial of Service Prevention

SCT can be monitored in the Denial of Service > Denial of Service Prevention > Security Suite Settings page (Details button).

Types of DoS Attacks


A Denial of Service attack can be caused in the following ways (among others): TCP SYN PacketsA flood of TCP SYN packets, often with a false sender address, can signify an attack. Each of these packets causes the device to spawn a half-open connection, by sending back a TCP/SYN-ACK packet (Acknowledge), and waiting for a packet in response from the sender address (response to the ACK Packet). However, because the sender address is false, the response never comes. These half-open connections saturate the number of available connections the device is able to make, keeping it from responding to legitimate requests. In addition, the potential number of packets to the CPU is limited and the attack traffic might consume this number of packets. These packets can be blocked in the SYN Protection page. TCP SYN-FIN Packets SYN packets are sent to create a new TCP connection. TCP FIN packets are sent to close a connection. A packet in which both SYN and FIN flags are set should never exist. Therefore these packets might signify an attack on the device and should be blocked. A definition of what constitutes a SYN attack can be set in the SYN Protection page. When the device identifies such an attack on an interface, it is reported in this page.

Defense Against DoS Attacks


The Denial of Service (DoS) Prevention feature assists the system administrator in resisting DoS attacks in the following ways: Enable TCP SYN protection. If this feature is enabled, reports are issued when a SYN packet attack is identified. A SYN attack is identified if the number of SYN packets per second exceeds a user-configured threshold. SYN-FIN packets can be blocked.

Dependencies Between Features


There is no dependency between this feature and other features.

257

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Denial of Service Prevention

17

Default Configuration
The DoS Prevention feature has the following defaults: The DoS Prevention feature is disabled by default. SYN-FIN protection is enabled by default (even if DoS Prevention is disabled). If SYN protection is enabled, the default is Report.The default threshold is 30 SYN packets per second. All other DoS Prevention features are disabled by default.

Configuring DoS Prevention


The following pages are used to configure this feature.

Security Suite Settings


To configure DoS Prevention global settings and monitor SCT:
STEP 1 Click Security > Denial of Service Prevention > Security Suite Settings. The

Security Suite Settings appears. CPU Protection Mechanism: Enabled indicates that SCT is enabled.
STEP 2 Click Details beside CPU Utilization to go to the CPU Utilization page and view

CPU resource utilization information.


STEP 3 Click Edit beside TCP SYN Protection to go to the SYN Protection page and

enable this feature.

SYN Protection
The network ports might be used by hackers to attack the switch in a SYN attack, which consumes TCP resources (buffers) and CPU power. Since the CPU is protected using SCT, TCP traffic to the CPU is limited. However, if one or more ports are attacked with a high rate of SYN packets, the CPU receives only the attacker packets, thus creating Denial-of-Service. When using the SYN protection feature, the CPU counts the SYN packets ingressing from each network port to the CPU per second. If the number is higher than the threshold, a SYSLOG message is generated, but the packets are not blocked.
Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide 258

17
To configure SYN protection: Protection page appears.
STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

Security
Denial of Service Prevention

STEP 1 Click Security > Denial of Service Prevention > SYN Protection. The SYN

Block SYN-FIN PacketsSelect to enable the feature. If TCP packets with both SYN and FIN flags are detected, a SYSLOG message is generated. SYN Protection ModeSelect between three modes: DisableThe feature is disabled on a specific interface. ReportGenerates a SYSLOG message.The status of the port is changed to Attacked when the threshold is passed.

SYN Protection ThresholdNumber of SYN packets per second before SYN packets will be blocked (deny SYN with MAC-to-me rule will be applied on the port). SYN Protection PeriodTime in seconds before unblocking the SYN packets (the deny SYN with MAC-to-me rule is unbound from the port).

STEP 3 Click Apply. SYN protection is defined, and the Running Configuration file is

updated.
STEP 4 The SYN Protection Interface Table contains the following fields for every port or

LAG (as requested by the user) Current StatusInterface status. The possible values are: NormalNo attack was identified on this interface. AttackedAttack was identified on this interface.

Last AttackDate of last SYN-FIN attack identified by the system and the system action (Reported).

259

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security
Denial of Service Prevention

17

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

260

18
Security: SSL Server
This section describes the Secure Socket Layer (SSL) feature. It contains the following topics: SSL Overview Default Settings and Configuration SSL Server Authentication Settings

SSL Overview
The Secure Socket Layer (SSL) feature is used to open an HTTPS session to the device. An HTTPS session may be opened with the default certificate that exists on the device. Some browsers generate warnings when using a default certificate, since this certificate is not signed by a Certification Authority (CA). It is best practice to have a certificate signed by a trusted CA. To open an HTTPS session with a user-created certificate, perform the following actions: 1. Generate a certificate. 2. Request that the certificate be certified by a CA. 3. Import the signed certificate into the device.

Default Settings and Configuration


By default, the switch contains a certificate that can be modified.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

261

Security: SSL Server


SSL Server Authentication Settings

18

HTTPS is enabled by default.

SSL Server Authentication Settings


It may be required to generate a new certificate to replace the default certificate found on the device. To create a new certificate, modify an existing one, or import a certificate:
STEP 1 Click Security > SSL Server > SSL Server Authentication Settings. The SSL

Server Authentication Settings page appears. Information appears for certificate 1 and 2 in the SSL Server Key Table. These fields are defined in the Edit page except for the following fields: Valid FromSpecifies the date from which the certificate is valid. Valid ToSpecifies the date up to which the certificate is valid. Certificate SourceSpecifies whether the certificate was generated by the system (Auto Generated) or the user (User Defined).

STEP 2 Select an active certificate. STEP 3 You can perform one of the following actions by clicking the relevant button:

EditSelect one of the certificates and enter the following fields for it: Regenerate RSA KeySelect to regenerate the RSA key. Key LengthEnter the length of the RSA key to be generated. Common NameSpecifies the fully-qualified device URL or IP address. If unspecified, defaults to the lowest IP address of the device (when the certificate is generated). Organization UnitSpecifies the organization-unit or department name. Organization NameSpecifies the organization name. LocationSpecifies the location or city name. StateSpecifies the state or province name. CountrySpecifies the country name. DurationSpecifies the number of days a certification is valid.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

262

18
CA.

Security: SSL Server


SSL Server Authentication Settings

Generate Certificate RequestGenerate a certificate request to be signed by a CA. Enter the fields for the certificate (same as fields in Edit page).

STEP 4 Click Generate Certificate Request. This creates a key that must be entered on the

Import CertificateWhen the approval is received from the CA, enter the following: Certificate IDSelect the active certificate. CertificateCopy in the received certificate. Import RSA KEY-PairSelect to enable copying in the new RSA key-pair. Public KeyCopy in the RSA public key. Private Key (Encrypted)Select and copy in the RSA private key in encrypted form. Private Key (Plaintext)Select and copy in the RSA private key in plain text form. Display Sensitive Data as EncryptedClick this button to display this key as encrypted. When this button is clicked, the private keys are written to the configuration file in encrypted form (when Apply is clicked).

DetailsDisplays the certificate and RSA key pair. This is used to copy the certificate and RSA key-pair to another device (using copy/paste). When you click Display Sensitive Data as Encrypted., the private keys are displayed in encrypted form.

STEP 5 Click Apply to apply the changes to the Running Configuration.

263

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security: SSL Server


SSL Server Authentication Settings

18

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

264

19
Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management
Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) is an architecture that facilitates the protection of sensitive data on a device, such as passwords and keys. The facility makes use of passphrases, encryption, access control, and user authentication to provide a secure solution to managing sensitive data. The facility is extended to protect the integrity of configuration files, to secure the configuration process, and to support SSD zero-touch auto configuration. Introduction SSD Rules SSD Properties Configuration Files SSD Management Channels Menu CLI and Password Recovery Configuring SSD

Introduction
SSD protects sensitive data on a device, such as passwords and keys, permits and denies access to sensitive data encrypted and in plain text based on user credentials and SSD rules, and protects configuration files containing sensitive data from being tampered with. In addition, SSD enables the secure backup and sharing of configuration files containing sensitive data. SSD provides users with the flexibility to configure the desired level of protection on their sensitive data; from no protection with sensitive data in plaintext, minimum
protection with encryption based on the default passphrase, and better protection with encryption based on user-defined passphrase.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

265

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Rules

19

SSD grants read permission to sensitive data only to authenticated and authorized users, and according to SSD rules. A device authenticates and authorizes management access to users through the user authentication process.

Whether or not SSD is used, it is recommended that an administrator should secure the authentication process by using the local authentication database, and/ or secure the communication to external authentication server (RADIUS and TACACS) used in the user authentication process.
In summary, SSD protects sensitive data on a device with SSD rules, SSD properties, and user authentication. And SSD rules, SSD properties, and user authentication configurations of the device are themselves sensitive data protected by SSD.

SSD Management
SSD management includes a collection of configuration parameters that define the handling and security of sensitive data. The SSD configuration parameters themselves are sensitive data and are protected under SSD. All configuration of SSD is performed through the SSD pages that are only available to users with the correct permissions (see SSD Rules).

SSD Rules
SSD rules define the read permissions and default read mode given to a user session on a management channel. An SSD rule is uniquely identified by its user and SSD management channel. Different SSD rules might exist for the same user but for different channels, and conversely, different rules might exist for the same channel but for different users. Read permissions determine how sensitive data can be viewed: in only encrypted form, in only plaintext form, in both encrypted or plaintext, or no permission to view sensitive data. The SSD rules themselves are protected as sensitive data. A device can support a total of 32 SSD rules. A device grants a user the SSD read permission of the SSD rule that best matches the user identity/credential and the type of management channel from which the user is/will access the sensitive data. A device comes with a set of default SSD rules. An administrator can add, delete, and change SSD rules as desired.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

266

19
Elements of an SSD Rule

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Rules

NOTE A device may not support all the channels defined by SSD.

An SSD rule includes the following elements: User typeThe user types supported in order of most preference to least preference are as follows: (If a user matches multiple SSD rules, the rule with the most preference User Type will be applied). SpecificThe rule applies to a specific user. Default User (cisco)The rule applies to the default user (cisco). Level 15The rule applies to users with privilege level 15. AllThe rule applies to all users.

User NameIf user type is Specific, a user name is required. Channel. Type of SSD management channel to which the rule is applied. The channel types supported are: SecureSpecifies the rule applies only to secure channels. Depending on the device, it may support some or all of the following secure channels: Console port interface, SCP, SSH, and HTTPS. InsecureSpecifies that this rule applies only to insecure channels. Depending on the device, it may support some or all of the following insecure channels: Telnet, TFTP, and HTTP. Secure XML SNMPSpecifies that this rule applies only to XML over HTTPSwith privacy. A device may or may not support all of the secure XML and SNMP channels. Insecure XML SNMPSpecifies that this rule applies only to XML over HTTP /without privacy. A device may or may not support all of the secure XML and SNMP channels.

Read PermissionThe read permissions associate with the rules. These can be the following: (Lowest) ExcludeUsers are not permitted to access sensitive data in any form. (Middle) Encrypted OnlyUsers are permitted to access sensitive data as encrypted only.
Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

267

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Rules

19

(Higher) Plaintext OnlyUsers are permitted to access sensitive data in plaintext only. Users will also have read and write permission to SSD parameters as well. (Highest) BothUsers have both encrypted and plaintext permissions and are permitted to access sensitive data as encrypted and in plaintext. Users will also have read and write permission to SSD parameters as well.

Each management channel allows specific read permissions. The following summarizes these. Table 1 Read Permissions Allowed per Management Channel Management Channel Secure Insecure Secure XML SNMP Insecure XML SNMP Read Permission Options Allowed Both, Encrypted Only Both, Encrypted Only Exclude, Plaintext Only Exclude, Plaintext Only

Default Read ModeAll default read modes are subjected to the read permission of the rule. The following options exist, but some might be rejected, depending on the read permission. If the user-defined read permission for a user is Exclude (for example), and the default read mode is Encrypted, the user-defined read permission prevails. ExcludeDo not allow reading sensitive data. EncryptedSensitive data is presented in encrypted form. PlaintextSensitive data is presented in plaintext form.

Each management channel allows specific read presumptions. The following summarizes these. Table 2 Default Read Modes for Read Permissions Read Permission Exclude Encrypted Only Plaintext Only Default Read Mode Allowed Exclude *Encrypted *Plaintext

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

268

19
Table 2 Read Permission Both

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Rules

Default Read Modes for Read Permissions Default Read Mode Allowed *Plaintext, Encrypted

* The Read mode of a session can be temporarily changed in the SSD Properties page if the new read mode does not violate the read permission.
NOTE Note the following:

The default Read mode for the Secure XML SNMP and Insecure XML SNMP management channels must be identical to their read permission. Read permission Exclude is allowed only for Secure XML SNMP and Insecure XML SNMP management channels; Exclude is not allowed for regular secure and insecure channels. Exclude sensitive data in secure and Insecure XML-SNMP management channels means that the sensitive data is presented as a 0 (meaning null string or numeric 0). If the user wants to view sensitive data, the rule must be changed to plaintext. By default, an SNMPv3 user with privacy and XML-over-secure channels permissions is considered to be a level-15 user. SNMP users on Insecure XML and SNMP (SNMPv1,v2, and v3 with no privacy) channel are considered as All users. There must always be at least one rule with read permission: Plaintext Only or Both, because only users with those permissions are able to access the SSD pages. Changes in the default read mode and read permissions of a rule will become effective, and will be applied to the affected user(s) and channel of all active management sessions immediately, excluding the session making the changes even if the rule is applicable. When a rule is changed (add, delete, edit), a system will update all the affected CLI/GUI sessions.
NOTE When the SSD rule applied upon the session login is changed from

within that session, the user must log out and back in to see the change.

SSD Rules and User Authentication


SSD grants SSD permission only to authenticated and authorized users and according to the SSD rules. A device depends on its user authentication process to authenticate and authorize management access. To protect a device and its data including sensitive data and SSD configurations from unauthorized access, it
269 Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Rules

19

is recommended that the user authentication process on a device is secured. To secure the user authentication process, you can use the local authentication database, as well as secure the communication through external authentication servers, such as RADIUS and TACACS servers. The configuration of the secure communication to the external authentication servers are sensitive data and are protected under SSD.
NOTE The user credential in the local authenticated database is already protected by a

non SSD related mechanism If a user from a channel issues an action that uses an alternate channel, the device applies the read permission and default read mode from the SSD rule that match the user credential and the alternate channel. For example, if a user logs in via a secure channel and starts a TFTP upload session, the SSD read permission of the user on the insecure channel (TFTP) is applied

Default SSD Rules


The device has the following factory default rules: Table 3 User Level 15 Level 15 Level 15 All All All Default SSD Rules Rule Action Channel Secure XML SNMP Secure Insecure Insecure XML SNMP Secure Insecure Read Permission Plaintext Only Both Both Exclude Encrypted Only Encrypted Only Default Read Mode Plaintext Encrypted Encrypted Exclude Encrypted Encrypted

Rule Key

The default rules can be modified, but they cannot be deleted. If the SSD default rules have been changed, they can be restored.

SSD Default Read Mode Session Override


The system contains sensitive data in a session, as either encrypted or plaintext, based on the read permission and the default read mode of the user.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

270

19

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Properties

The default read mode can be temporarily overridden as long it does not conflict with the SSD read permission of the session. This change is effective immediately in the current session, until one of the following occurs: User changes it again. Session is terminated. The read permission of the SSD rule that is applied to the session user is changed and is no longer compatible with the current read mode of the session. In this case, the session read mode returns to the default read mode of the SSD rule.

SSD Properties
SSD properties are a set of parameters that, in conjunction with the SSD rules, define and control the SSD environment of a device. The SSD environment consists of these properties: Controlling how the sensitive data is encrypted. Controlling the strength of security on configuration files. Controlling how the sensitive data is viewed within the current session.

Passphrase
A passphrase is the basis of the security mechanism in the SSD feature, and is used to generate the key for the encryption and decryption of sensitive data. Sx200, Sx300, Sx500, and SG500X/ESW2-550X series switches that have the same passphrase are able to decrypt each other's sensitive data encrypted with the key generated from the passphrase. A passphrase must comply with the following rules: LengthBetween 8-16 characters. Character ClassesThe passphrase must have at least one upper case character, one lower case character, one numeric character, and one special character e.g. #,$.

271

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Properties

19

Default and User-defined Passphrases


All devices come with a default, out-of-the box passphrase that is transparent to users. The default passphrase is never displayed in the configuration file or in the CLI/GUI. If better security and protection are desired, an administrator should configure SSD on a device to use a user-defined passphrase instead of the default passphrase. A user-defined passphrase should be treated as a well-guard secret, so that the security of the sensitive data on the device is not compromised. A user-defined passphrase can be configured manually in plain text. It can also be derived from a configuration file. (See Sensitive Data Zero-Touch Auto Configuration). A device always displays user-defined passphrases encrypted.

Local Passphrase
A device maintains a local passphrase which is the passphrase of its Running Configuration. SSD normally performs encryption and decryption of sensitive data with the key generated from the local passphrase. The local passphrase can be configured to be either the default passphrase or a user-defined passphrase. By default, the local passphrase and default passphrase are identical. It can be changed by administrative actions from either the Command Line Interface (if available) or the web-based interface. It is automatically changed to the passphrase in the startup configuration file, when the startup configuration becomes the running configuration of the device. When a device is reset to factory default, the local passphrase is reset to the default passphrase.

Configuration File Passphrase Control


File passphrase control provides additional protection for a user-defined passphrase, and the sensitive data that are encrypted with the key generated from the user-defined passphrase, in text-based configuration files. The following are the existing passphrase control modes: Unrestricted (default)The device includes its passphrase when creating a configuration file. This enables any device accepting the configuration file to learn the passphrase from the file. RestrictedThe device restricts its passphrase from being exported into a configuration file. Restricted mode protects the encrypted sensitive data in

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

272

19

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Properties

a configuration file from devices that do not have the passphrase. This mode should be used when a user does not want to expose the passphrase in a configuration file. After a device is reset to the factory default, its local passphrase is reset to the default passphrase. As a result, the device will be not able to decrypt any sensitive data encrypted based on a user-defined passphrase entered from a management session (GUI/CLI), or in any configuration file with restricted mode, including the files created by the device itself before it is reset to factory default. This remains until the device is manually reconfigured with the user-defined passphrase, or learns the user-defined passphrase from a configuration file.

Configuration File Integrity Control


A user can protect a configuration file from being tampered or modified by creating the configuration file with Configuration File Integrity Control. It is recommended that Configuration File Integrity Control be enabled when a device uses a user-defined passphrase with Unrestricted Configuration File Passprhase Control.

!
CAUTION Any modification made to a configuration file that is integrity protected is

considered tampering. A device determines whether the integrity of a configuration file is protected by examining the File Integrity Control command in the file's SSD Control block. If a file is integrity protected but a device finds the integrity of the file is not intact, the device rejects the file. Otherwise, the file is accepted for further processing. A device checks for the integrity of a text-based configuration file when the file is downloaded or copied to the Startup Configuration file.

Read Mode
Each session has a Read mode. This determines how sensitive data appears. The Read mode can be either Plaintext, in which case sensitive data appears as regular text, or Encrypted, in which sensitive data appears in its encrypted form.

273

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Configuration Files

19

Configuration Files
A configuration file contains the configuration of a device. A device has a Running Configuration file, a Startup Configuration file, a Mirror Configuration file (optionally), and a Backup Configuration file. A user can manually upload and download a configuration file to and from a remote file-server. A device can automatically download its Startup Configuration from a remote file server during the auto configuration stage using DHCP. Configuration files stored on remote file servers are referred to as remote configuration files. A Running Configuration file contains the configuration currently being used by a device. The configuration in a Startup Configuration file becomes the Running Configuration after reboot. Running and Startup Configuration files are formatted in internal format. Mirror, Backup, and the remote configuration files are text-based files usually kept for archive, records, or recovery. During copying, uploading, and downloading a source configuration file, a device automatically transforms the source content to the format of the destination file if the two files are of different formats.

File SSD Indicator


When copying the Running or Startup Configuration file into a text-based configuration file, the device generates and places the file SSD indicator in the text-based configuration file to indicate whether the file contains encrypted sensitive data, plaintext sensitive data or excludes sensitive data. The SSD indicator, if it exists, must be in the configuration header file. A text-based configuration that does not include an SSD indicator is considered not to contain sensitive data. The SSD indicator is used to enforce SSD read permissions on text-based configuration files, but is ignored when copying the configuration files to the Running or Startup Configuration file.

The SSD indicator in a file is set according to the users instruction, during copy, to include encrypted, plaintext or exclude sensitive data from a file.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

274

19
SSD Control Block

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Configuration Files

When a device creates a text-based configuration file from its Startup or Running Configuration file, it inserts an SSD control block into the file if a user requests the file is to include sensitive data. The SSD control block, which is protected from tampering, contains SSD rules and SSD properties of the device creating the file. A SSD control block starts and ends with "ssd-control-start" and "ssd-control-end" respectively.

Startup Configuration File


The device currently supports copying from the Running, Backup, Mirror, and Remote Configuration files to a Startup Configuration file. The configurations in the Startup Configuration are effective and become the Running Configuration after reboot. A user can retrieve the sensitive data encrypted or in plaintext from a startup configuration file, subject to the SSD read permission and the current SSD read mode of the management session. Read access of sensitive data in the startup configuration in any forms is excluded if the passphrase in the Startup Configuration file and the local passphrase are different. SSD adds the following rules when copying the Backup, Mirror, and Remote Configuration files to the Startup Configuration file: After a device is reset to factory default, all of its configurations, including the SSD rules and properties are reset to default. If a source configuration file contains encrypted sensitive data, but is missing an SSD control block, the device rejects the source file and the copy fails. If there is no SSD control block in the source configuration file, the SSD configuration in the Startup Configuration file is reset to default. If there is a passphrase in the SSD control block of the source configuration file, the device will reject the source file, and the copy fails if there is encrypted sensitive data in the file not encrypted by the key generated from the passphrase in the SSD control block. If there is an SSD control block in the source configuration file and the file fails the SSD integrity check, and/or file integrity check, the device rejects the source file and fails the copy. If there is no passphrase in the SSD control block of the source configuration file, all the encrypted sensitive data in the file must be
Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

275

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Configuration Files

19

encrypted by either the key generated from the local passphrase, or the key generated from the default passphrase, but not both. Otherwise, the source file is rejected and the copy fails. The device configures the passphrase, passphrase control, and file integrity, if any, from the SSD Control Block in the source configuration file to the Startup Configuration file. It configures the Startup Configuration file with the passphrase that is used to generate the key to decrypt the sensitive data in the source configuration file. Any SSD configurations that are not found are reset to the default. If there is an SSD control block in the source configuration file and the file contains plaintext, sensitive data excluding the SSD configurations in the SSD control block, the file is accepted.

Running Configuration File


A Running Configuration file contains the configuration currently being used by the device. A user can retrieve the sensitive data encrypted or in plaintext from a running configuration file, subject to the SSD read permission and the current SSD read mode of the management session. The user can change the Running Configuration by copying the Backup or Mirror Configuration files through other management actions via CLI, XML,and so on. A device applies the following rules when a user directly changes the SSD configuration in the Running Configuration: If the user that opened the management session does not have SSD permissions (meaning read permissions of either Both or Plaintext Only), the device rejects all SSD commands. When copied from a source file, File SSD indicator, SSD Control Block Integrity, and SSD File Integrity are neither verified nor enforced. When copied from a source file, the copy will fail if the passphrase in the source file is in plaintext. If the passphrase is encrypted, it is ignored. When directly configuring the passphrase, (non file copy), in the Running Configuration, the passphrase in the command must be entered in plaintext. Otherwise, the command is rejected. Configuration commands with encrypted sensitive data, that are encrypted with the key generated from the local passphrase, are configured into the Running Configuration. Otherwise, the configuration command is in error, and is not incorporated into the Running Configuration file.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

276

19

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Configuration Files

Backup and Mirror Configuration File


A device periodically generates its Mirror Configuration file from the Startup Configuration file if auto mirror configuration service is enabled. A device always generates a Mirror Configuration file with encrypted sensitive data. Therefore, the File SSD Indicator in a Mirror Configuration file always indicates that the file contains encrypted sensitive data. By default, auto mirror configuration service is enabled. To configure auto mirror configuration to be enabled or disabled, click Administration > File Management > Configuration File Properties. A user can display, copy, and upload the complete mirror and backup configuration files, subject to SSD read permission, the current read mode in the session, and the file SSD indicator in the source file as follows: If there is no file SSD indicator in a mirror or backup configuration file, all users are allowed to access the file. A user with Both read permission can access all mirror and backup configuration files. However, if the current read mode of the session is different than the file SSD indicator, the user is presented with a prompt indicating that this action is not allowed. A user with Plaintext Only permission can access mirror and backup configuration files if their file SSD Indicator shows Exclude or Plaintext Only sensitive data. A user with Encrypted Only permission can access mirror and backup configuration files with their file SSD Indicator showing Exclude or Encrypted sensitive data. A user with Exclude permission cannot access mirror and backup configuration files with their file SSD indicator showing either encrypted or plaintext sensitive data.

The user should not manually change the file SSD indicator that conflicts with the sensitive data, if any, in the file. Otherwise, plaintext sensitive data may be unexpectedly exposed.

Sensitive Data Zero-Touch Auto Configuration


SSD Zero-touch Auto Configuration is the auto configuration of target devices with encrypted sensitive data, without the need to manually pre-configure the target devices with the passphrase whose key is used to encrypted the sensitive data.

277

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


SSD Management Channels

19

The device currently supports Auto Configuration, which is enabled by default. When Auto Configuration is enabled on a device and the device receives DHCP options that specify a file server and a boot file, the device downloads the boot file (remote configuration file) into the Startup Configuration file from a file server, and then reboots.
NOTE The file server may be specified by the bootp siaddr and sname

fields, as well as DHCP option 150 and statically configured on the device. The user can safely auto configure target devices with encrypted sensitive data, by first creating the configuration file that is to be used in the auto configuration from a device that contains the configurations. The device must be configured and instructed to: Encrypt the sensitive data in the file Enforce the integrity of the file content Include the secure, authentication configuration commands and SSD rules that properly control and secure the access to devices and the sensitive data

If the configuration file was generated with a user passphrase and SSD file passphrase control is Restricted, the resulting configuration file can be autoconfigured to the desired target devices. However, for auto configuration to succeed with a user-defined passphrase, the target devices must be manually pre-configured with the same passphrase as the device that generates the files, which is not zero touch. If the device creating the configuration file is in Unrestricted passphrase control mode, the device includes the passphrase in the file. As a result, the user can auto configure the target devices, including devices that are out-of-the-box or in factory default, with the configuration file without manually pre-configuring the target devices with the passphrase. This is zero touch because the target devices learn the passphrase directly from the configuration file.

SSD Management Channels


Devices can be managed over management channels such as telnet, SSH, and web. SSD categories the channels into the following types based on their security and/or protocols: secured, insecure, secure-XML-SNMP, and insecure-XML-SNMP. The following describes whether SSD considers each management channel to be secure or insecure. If it is insecure, the table indicates the parallel secure channel.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

278

19
Management Channels Management Channel GUI/HTTP GUI/HTTPS XML/HTTP XML/HTTPS TFTP HTTP based file transfer HTTPS based file transfer

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Menu CLI and Password Recovery

Security of Management Channels

SSD Management Channel Type Insecure Secure Insecure-XMLSNMP Secure-XML-SNMP Insecure Insecure Secure

Parallel Secured Management Channel GUI/HTTPS

XML/HTTPS

HTTPS-based file transfer

Menu CLI and Password Recovery


The Menu CLI interface is only allowed to users if their read permissions are Both or Plaintext Only. Other users are rejected. Sensitive data in the Menu CLI is always displayed as plaintext. Password recovery is currently activated from the boot menu and allows the user to log on to the terminal without authentication. If SSD is supported, this option is only permitted if the local passphrase is identical to the default passphrase. If a device is configured with a user-defined passphrase, the user is unable to activate password recovery.

Configuring SSD
The SSD feature is configured in the following pages: SSD properties are set in the Properties page. SSD rules are defined in the SSD Rules page.

279

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Configuring SSD

19

SSD Properties
Only users with SSD read permission of Plaintext-only or Both are allowed to set SSD properties. To configure global SSD properties:
STEP 1 Click Security > Secure Sensitive Data Management > Properties. The

Properties page appears. The following field appears: Current Local Passphrase TypeDisplays whether the default passphrase or a user-defined passphrase is currently being used.

STEP 2 Enter the following Persistent Settings fields:

Configuration File Passphrase ControlSelect an option as described in Configuration File Passphrase Control. Configuration File Integrity ControlSelect to enable this feature. See Configuration File Integrity Control.

STEP 3 Select a Read mode for the current session (see Elements of an SSD Rule).

To change the local passphrase:


STEP 4 Click Change Local Passphrase, and enter a new Local Passphrase:

DefaultUse the devices default passphrase. User Defined (Plaintext)Enter and confirm a new passphrase.

SSD Rules
Only users with SSD read permission of Plaintext-only or Both are allowed to set SSD rules. To configure SSD rules:
STEP 1 Click Security > Secure Sensitive Data Management > SSD Rules. The SSD

Rules page appears. The currently-defined rules are displayed.


STEP 2 To add a new rule, click Add. Enter the following fields:

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

280

19

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Configuring SSD

UserThis defines the user(s) to which the rule applies: Select one of the following options: Specific UserSelect and enter the specific user name to which this rule applies (this user does not necessarily have to be defined). Default User (cisco)Indicates that this rule applies to the default user. Level 15Indicates that this rule applies to all users with privilege level 15. AllIndicates that this rule applies to all users.

ChannelThis defines the security level of the input channel to which the rule applies: Select one of the following options: SecureIndicates that this rule applies only to secure channels (console, SSH and HTTPS), not including the XML channels. InsecureIndicates that this rule applies only to insecure channels (Telnet, TFTP and HTTP), not including the XML channels. Secure XML SNMPIndicates that this rule applies only to XML over HTTPS with privacy. Insecure XML SNMPIndicates that this rule applies only to XML over HTTP or without privacy.

Read PermissionThe read permissions associated with the rule. These can be the following: ExcludeLowest read permission. Users are not permitted to get sensitive data in any form. Plaintext OnlyHigher read permission than above ones. Users are permitted to get sensitive data in plaintext only. Encrypted OnlyMiddle read permission. Users are permitted to get sensitive data as encrypted only. Both (Plaintext and Encrypted)Highest read permission. Users have both encrypted and plaintext permissions and are permitted to get sensitive data as encrypted and in plaintext

Default Read ModeAll default read modes are subjected to the read permission of the rule. The following options exist, but some might be rejected, depending on the rules read permission. ExcludeDo not allow reading the sensitive data.

281

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Security: Secure Sensitive Data Management


Configuring SSD

19

EncryptedSensitive data is presented encrypted. PlaintextSensitive data is presented as plaintext.

STEP 3 The following actions can be performed:

Restore to DefaultRestore a user-modified default rule to the default rule. Restore All Rules to DefaultRestore all user-modified default rules to the default rule and remove all user-defined rules.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

282

20
Quality of Service
The Quality of Service feature is applied throughout the network to ensure that network traffic is prioritized according to required criteria and the desired traffic receives preferential treatment. This section covers the following topics: QoS Features and Components Configuring QoS - General Managing QoS Statistics

QoS Features and Components


The QoS feature is used to optimize network performance. QoS provides the following: Classification of incoming traffic to traffic classes, based on attributes, including: Device Configuration Ingress interface Packet content Combination of these attributes

QoS includes the following: Traffic ClassificationClassifies each incoming packet as belonging to a specific traffic flow, based on the packet contents and/or the port. Assignment to Hardware QueuesAssigns incoming packets to forwarding queues. Packets are sent to a particular queue for handling as a function of the traffic class to which they belong.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

283

Quality of Service
QoS Features and Components

20
Other Traffic Class-Handling AttributeApplies QoS mechanisms to various classes, including bandwidth management.

QoS Operation
When using the QoS feature, all traffic of the same class receives the same treatment, which consists of a single QoS action of determining the egress queue on the egress port, based on the indicated QoS value in the incoming frame. This is the VLAN Priority Tag (VPT) 802.1p value in Layer 2 and the Differentiated Service Code Point (DSCP) value for IPv4 or Traffic Class (TC) value for IPv6 in Layer 3. When operating in Basic Mode, the switch trusts this external assigned QoS value. The external assigned QoS value of a packet determines its traffic class and QoS. The type of header field to be trusted is entered in the Global Settings page. For every value of that field, an egress queue is assigned, indicating through which queue the frame is sent, in the CoS/802.1p to Queue page or the DSCP to Queue page (depending on whether the trust mode is CoS/802.1p or DSCP, respectively).

QoS Workflow
To configure general QoS parameters, perform the following:
STEP 1 Enable QoS by using the QoS Properties page to select the trust mode. Then

enable QoS on ports by using the Interface Settings page.


STEP 2 Assign each interface a default CoS or DSCP priority by using the QoS Properties

page.
STEP 3 Assign the schedule method (Strict Priority or WRR) and bandwidth allocation for

WRR to the egress queues by using the Queue page.


STEP 4 Designate an egress queue to each IP DSCP/TC value with the DSCP to Queue

page. If the switch is in DSCP trusted mode, incoming packets are put into the egress queues based on the their DSCP/TC value.
STEP 5 Designate an egress queue to each CoS/802.1p priority. If the switch is in CoS/

802.1 trusted mode, all incoming packets are put into the designated egress queues according to the CoS/802.1p priority in the packets. This is done by using the CoS/802.1p to Queue page.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

284

20
STEP 6 Enter bandwidth and rate limits in the following pages:

Quality of Service
Configuring QoS - General

a. Set egress shaping per queue by using the Egress Shaping Per Queue page. b. Set ingress rate limit and egress shaping rate per port by using the Bandwidth page.

Configuring QoS - General


The QoS Properties Page contains fields for enabling QoS and selecting the trust mode to be used. In addition, the default CoS priority or DSCP value for each interface can be defined.

Setting QoS Properties


To enable QoS:
STEP 1 Click Quality of Service > General > QoS Properties. The QoS Properties page

appears.
STEP 2 Enable QoS on the switch. STEP 3 Select a trust mode (CoS/802.1p or DSCP) and click Apply. STEP 4 If you selected DSCP, proceed to STEP 6; if you selected CoS, proceed to the next

step.
STEP 5 Select Port/LAG and click GO to display/modify all ports/LAGs on the device and

their CoS information. The following fields are displayed for all ports/LAGs: InterfaceType of interface. Default CoSDefault VPT value for incoming packets that do not have a VLAN Tag. The default CoS is 0. The default is only relevant for untagged frames if Trust CoS is selected.

Select Restore Defaults to restore the factory CoS default setting for this interface.
STEP 6 Click DSCP Override Table to enter the DSCP values. The DSCP Override Table

appears.

285

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Quality of Service
Configuring QoS - General

20
marked to an alternative value. Select the new DSCP value to override the incoming value. Select Restore Defaults to restore the factory DSCP values.

STEP 7 DSCP In shows the DSCP value of the incoming packet that needs to be re-

STEP 8 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

To set QoS on an interface, select it, and click Edit . The Edit Interface CoS Configuration page appears.
STEP 1 Enter the parameters.

InterfaceSelect the port or LAG. Default CoSSelect the default CoS (Class-of-Service) value to be assigned for incoming packets (that do not have a VLAN tag).

STEP 2 Click Apply. The interface default CoS value is written to Running Configuration

file.

Interface QoS Settings


The Interface Settings page enables configuring QoS on each port of the switch, as follows: QoS State Disabled on an InterfaceAll inbound traffic on the port is mapped to the best effort queue and no classification/prioritization takes place. QoS State of the Port is EnabledPort prioritize traffic on ingress is based on the system wide configured trusted mode, which is either CoS/ 802.1p trusted mode or DSCP trusted mode. To enter QoS settings per interface:
STEP 1 Click Quality of Service > General > Interface Settings. The Interface Settings

page appears.
STEP 2 Select Port or LAG to display the list of ports or LAGs.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

286

20

Quality of Service
Configuring QoS - General

The list of ports/LAGs appears. QoS State shows whether QoS is enabled on the interface.
STEP 3 Select an interface, and click Edit . The Edit QoS Interface Settings appears. STEP 4 Select the Port or LAG interface. STEP 5 Click to enable or disable QoS State for this interface. STEP 6 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

Configuring QoS Queues


The switch supports four queues for each interface. Queue number four is the highest priority queue. Queue number one is the lowest priority queue. There are two ways of determining how traffic in queues is handled, Strict Priority and Weighted Round Robin (WRR). Strict PriorityEgress traffic from the highest-priority queue is transmitted first. Traffic from the lower queues is processed only after the highest queue has been transmitted, thus providing the highest level of priority of traffic to the highest numbered queue. Weighted Round Robin (WRR)In WRR mode the number of packets sent from the queue is proportional to the weight of the queue (the higher the weight the more frames are sent). For example, if all four queues are WRR and the default weights are used, queue1 receives 1/15 of the bandwidth (assuming all queues are saturated and there is congestion), queue 2 receives 2/15, queue 3 receives 4/ 15 and queue 4 receives 8 /15 of the bandwidth. The type of WRR algorithm used in the device is not the standard Deficit WRR (DWRR), but rather Shaped Deficit WRR (SDWRR). The queuing modes can be selected in the Queue page. When the queuing mode is by strict priority, the priority sets the order in which queues are serviced, starting with queue_4 (the highest priority queue) and going to the next lower queue when each queue is completed. When the queuing mode is Weighted Round Robin, queues are serviced until their quota has been used up and then another queue is serviced.

287

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Quality of Service
Configuring QoS - General

20
It is also possible to assign some of the lower queues to WRR, while keeping some of the higher queues in strict priority. In this case traffic for the strict priority queues is always sent before traffic from the WRR queues. Only after the strict priority queues have been emptied is traffic from the WRR queues forwarded. (The relative portion from each WRR queue depends on its weight). To select the priority method and enter WRR data.

STEP 1 Click Quality of Service > General > Queue. The Queue page appears. STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

QueueDisplays the queue number. Scheduling Method: Select one of the following options: -

Strict PriorityTraffic scheduling for the selected queue and all higher queues is based strictly on the queue priority. WRRTraffic scheduling for the selected queue is based on WRR. The
period time is divided between the WRR queues that are not empty, meaning they have descriptors to egress. This happens only if strict priority queues are empty.

WRR WeightIf WRR is selected, enter the WRR weight assigned to the
queue.

% of WRR BandwidthDisplays the amount of bandwidth assigned to the queue. These values represent the percent of the WRR weight.

STEP 3 Click Apply. The queues are configured, and the Running Configuration file is

updated.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

288

20
Mapping CoS/802.1p to a Queue

Quality of Service
Configuring QoS - General

The CoS/802.1p to Queue page maps 802.1p priorities to egress queues. The CoS/802.1p to Queue Table determines the egress queues of the incoming packets based on the 802.1p priority in their VLAN Tags. For incoming untagged packets, the 802.1p priority is the default CoS/802.1p priority assigned to the ingress ports. Default Mapping Queues 802.1p Values (0-7, 7 being the highest) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Queue (4 queues 14, 4 being the highest priority) 1 1 2 3 3 4 4 4 Queue (2 queues: Normal and High) Normal Normal Normal Normal Normal High High High Notes

Background Best Effort Excellent Effort Critical Application LVS phone SIP Video Voice Cisco IP phone default Interwork Control LVS phone RTP Network Control

By changing the CoS/802.1p to Queue mapping and the Queue schedule method and bandwidth allocation, it is possible to achieve the desired quality of services in a network. CoS/802.1p to Queue mapping is applicable only if CoS/802.1p is the trusted mode and the packets belong to flows that are CoS trusted.

289

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Quality of Service
Configuring QoS - General

20
Queue 1 has the lowest priority, queue 4 has the highest priority. To map CoS values to egress queues:

STEP 1 Click Quality of Service > General > CoS/802.1p to Queue. The CoS/802.1p to

Queue page appears.


STEP 2 Enter the parameters.

802.1pDisplays the 802.1p priority tag values to be assigned to an egress queue, where 0 is the lowest and 7 is the highest priority. Output QueueSelect the egress queue to which the 802.1p priority is mapped. Four egress queues are supported, where Queue 4 is the highest priority egress queue and Queue1 is the lowest priority.

STEP 3 For each 802.1p priority, select the Output Queue to which it is mapped. STEP 4 Click Apply. 801.1p priority values to queues are mapped, and the Running

Configuration file is updated.

Mapping DSCP to Queue


The DSCP (IP Differentiated Services Code Point) to Queue page maps DSCP to egress queues. The DSCP to Queue Table determines the egress queues of the incoming IP packets based on their DSCP values. The original VPT (VLAN Priority Tag) of the packet is unchanged. By simply changing the DSCP to Queue mapping and the Queue schedule method and bandwidth allocation, it is possible to achieve the desired quality of services in a network. DSCP to Queue mapping is applicable to IP packets if DSCP is the trusted mode. Non-IP packets are always classified to the best-effort queue

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

290

20
To map DSCP to queues: appears.

Quality of Service
Configuring QoS - General

STEP 1 Click Quality of Service > General > DSCP to Queue. The DSCP to Queue page

The DSCP to Queue page contains Ingress DSCP. It contains the DSCP value in the incoming packet and its associated class.
STEP 2 Select the Output Queue (traffic forwarding queue) to which the DSCP value is

mapped.
STEP 3 Click Apply. The Running Configuration file is updated.

Configuring Bandwidth
The Bandwidth page enables users to define two values, Ingress Rate Limit and Egress Shaping Rate, which determine how much traffic the system can receive and send. The ingress rate limit is the number of bits per second that can be received from the ingress interface. Excess bandwidth above this limit is discarded. The following values are entered for egress shaping: Committed Information Rate (CIR) sets the average maximum amount of data allowed to be sent on the egress interface, measured in bits per second Committed Burst Size (CBS) is the burst of data that is allowed to be sent, even though it is above the CIR. This is defined in number of bytes of data.

To enter bandwidth limitation:


STEP 1 Click Quality of Service > General > Bandwidth. The Bandwidth page appears.

The Bandwidth page contains bandwidth information for each interface. The % column is the ingress rate limit for the port divided by the total port bandwidth.
STEP 2 Select an interface, and click Edit . The Edit Bandwidth page appears. STEP 3 Select the Port or LAG interface. STEP 4 Enter the fields for the selected interface:

291

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Quality of Service
Configuring QoS - General

20
Ingress Rate LimitSelect to enable the ingress rate limit, which is defined in the field below. Ingress Rate LimitEnter the maximum amount of bandwidth allowed on the interface.
NOTE The two Ingress Rate Limit fields do not appear when the interface type is LAG.

Ingress Committed Burst Size (CBS)Enter the maximum burst size of data for the ingress interface in bytes of data. This amount can be sent even if it temporarily increases the bandwidth beyond the allowed limit. This field is only available if the interface is a port. Egress Shaping RateSelect to enable egress shaping on the interface. Committed Information Rate (CIR)Enter the maximum bandwidth for the egress interface. Egress Committed Burst Size (CBS)Enter the maximum burst size of data for the egress interface in bytes of data. This amount can be sent even if it temporarily increases the bandwidth beyond the allowed limit.

STEP 5 Click Apply. The bandwidth settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

Configuring Egress Shaping per Queue


In addition to limiting transmission rate per port, which is done in the Bandwidth page, the switch can limit the transmission rate of selected egressing frames on a per-queue per-port basis. Egress rate limiting is performed by shaping the output load. The switch limits all frames except for management frames. Any frames that are not limited are ignored in the rate calculations, meaning that their size is not included in the limit total. Per-queue Egress rate shaping can be disabled.

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

292

20
To define egress shaping per queue: Shaping Per Queue page appears.

Quality of Service
Managing QoS Statistics

STEP 1 Click Quality of Service > General > Egress Shaping per Queue. The Egress

The Egress Shaping Per Queue page contains the rate limit and burst size for each queue.
STEP 2 Select an interface type (Port or LAG), and click Go. The list of Ports/LAGs

appears.
STEP 3 Select a Port/LAG, and click Edit . The Edit Egress Shaping Per Queue page

appears. This page enables shaping the egress for up to four queues on each interface.
STEP 4 Select the Interface. STEP 5 For each queue that is required, enter the following fields:

Enable ShapingSelect to enable egress shaping on this queue. Committed Information Rate (CIR)Enter the maximum rate (CIR) in Kbits per second (Kbps). CIR is the average maximum amount of data that can be sent. Committed Burst Size (CBS)Enter the maximum burst size (CBS) in bytes. CBS is the maximum burst of data allowed to be sent even if a burst exceeds CIR.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The bandwidth settings are written to the Running Configuration file.

Managing QoS Statistics


From this page you can manage the view queues statistics.

Viewing Queues Statistics


The Queues Statistics page contains queue statistics, including statistics of forwarded and dropped packets, based on interface, queue, and drop precedence.

293

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Quality of Service
Managing QoS Statistics

20
change is made in General > QoS Properties. To view Queues Statistics:

NOTE QoS Statistics are shown only when the switch is in QoS Advanced Mode only. This

STEP 1 Click Quality of Service > QoS Statistics > Queues Statistics. The Queues

Statistics page appears. This page contains the following fields: Refresh RateSelect the time period that passes before the interface Ethernet statistics are refreshed. The available options are: No RefreshStatistics are not refreshed. 15 SecStatistics are refreshed every 15 seconds. 30 SecStatistics are refreshed every 30 seconds. 60 SecStatistics are refreshed every 60 seconds.

Counter SetThe options are: Set 1Displays the statistics for Set 1 that contains all interfaces and queues with a high DP (Drop Precedence). Set 2Displays the statistics for Set 2 that contains all interfaces and queues with a low DP.

InterfaceQueue statistics are displayed for this interface. QueuePackets were forwarded or tail dropped from this queue. Drop PrecedenceLowest drop precedence has the lowest probability of being dropped. Total PacketsNumber of packets forwarded or tail dropped. Tail Drop PacketsPercentage of packets that were tail dropped.

STEP 2 Click Add. The Add Queues Statistics page appears. STEP 3 Enter the parameters.

Counter SetSelect the counter set: Set 1Displays the statistics for Set 1 that contains all interfaces and queues with a high DP (Drop Precedence).

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

294

20

Quality of Service
Managing QoS Statistics

Set 2Displays the statistics for Set 2 that contains all interfaces and queues with a low DP.

InterfaceQueue statistics are displayed for this interface. QueuePackets were forwarded or tail dropped from this queue. Drop PrecedenceLowest drop precedence has the lowest probability of being dropped. Total PacketsNumber of packets forwarded or tail dropped. Tail Drop PacketsPercentage of packets that were tail dropped.

STEP 4 Click Add. The Add Queues Statistics page appears. STEP 5 Enter the parameters.

Counter SetSelect the counter set: Set 1Displays the statistics for Set 1 that contains all interfaces and queues with a high DP (Drop Precedence). Set 2Displays the statistics for Set 2 that contains all interfaces and queues with a low DP.

InterfaceSelect the ports for which statistics are displayed. The options are: PortSelects the port on the selected unit number for which statistics are displayed. All PortsSpecifies that statistics are displayed for all ports.

QueueSelect the queue for which statistics are displayed. Drop PrecedenceEnter drop precedence that indicates the probability of being dropped.

STEP 6 Click Apply. The Queue Statistics counter is added, and the Running Configuration

file is updated.

295

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

Quality of Service
Managing QoS Statistics

20

Cisco Small Business 200 Series Smart Switch Administration Guide

296

Cisco and the Cisco logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Cisco and/or its affiliates in the U.S. and other countries. To view a list of Cisco trademarks, go to this URL: www.cisco.com/go/trademarks. Third-party trademarks mentioned are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship between Cisco and any other company. (1110R)

2010-2012 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved.

OL-22849-02

You might also like